Denon AVR-2808CI Owners Manual

Page 1
AV SURROUND RECEIVER
AVR-2808CI
Owner’s Manual
Page 2
n
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
CAUTION:
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral triangle, is intended to alert the user to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons.
The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the appliance.
WARNING:
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS APPLIANCE TO RAIN OR MOISTURE.
SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
1. Read Instructions – All the safety and operating instructions should be read before the product is operated.
2. Retain Instructions – The safety and operating instructions should be retained for future reference.
3. Heed Warnings – All warnings on the product and in the operating instructions should be adhered to.
4. Follow Instructions – All operating and use instructions should be followed.
5. Cleaning – Unplug this product from the wall outlet before cleaning. Do not use liquid cleaners or aerosol cleaners.
6. Attachments – Do not use attachments not recommended by the product manufacturer as they may cause hazards.
7. Water and Moisture – Do not use this product near water – for example, near a bath tub, wash bowl, kitchen sink, or laundry tub; in a wet basement; or near a swimming pool; and the like.
8. Accessories – Do not place this product on an unstable cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table. The product may fall, causing serious injury to a child or adult, and serious damage to the product. Use only with a cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table recommended by the manufacturer, or sold with the product. Any mounting of the product should
follow the manufacturer’s instructions, and should use a mounting accessory recommended by the manufacturer.
9. A product and cart combination should be moved
with care. Quick stops, excessive force, and uneven surfaces may cause the product and cart combination to overturn.
10. Ventilation – Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided for ventilation and to ensure reliable operation of the product and to protect it from overheating, and these openings must not be blocked or covered. The openings should never be blocked by placing the product on a bed, sofa, rug, or other similar surface. This product should not be placed in a built-in installation such as a bookcase or rack unless proper ventilation is provided or the manufacturer’s instructions have been adhered to.
11. Power Sources – This product should be operated only from the type of power source indicated on the marking label. If you are not sure of the type of power supply to your home, consult your product dealer or local power company. For products intended to operate from battery power, or other sources, refer to the operating instructions.
12. Grounding or Polarization – This product may be equipped with a polarized alternating-current line plug (a plug having one blade wider than the other). This plug will fit into the power outlet only one way. This is a safety feature. If you are unable to insert the plug fully into the outlet, try reversing the plug. If the plug should still fail to fit, contact your electrician to replace your obsolete outlet. Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized plug.
13. Power-Cord Protection – Power-supply cords should be routed so that they are not likely to be walked on or pinched by items placed upon or against them, paying particular attention to cords at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where they exit from the product.
15. Outdoor Antenna Grounding – If an outside antenna or cable system is connected to the product, be sure the antenna or cable system is grounded so as to provide some protection against voltage surges and built-up static charges. Article 810 of the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA 70, provides information with regard to proper grounding of the mast and supporting structure, grounding of the lead-in wire to an antenna discharge unit, size of grounding conductors, location of antenna-discharge unit, connection to grounding electrodes, and requirements for the grounding electrode. See Figure A.
16. Lightning – For added protection for this product during a lightning storm, or when it is left unattended and unused for long periods of time, unplug it from the wall outlet and disconnect the antenna or cable system. This will prevent damage to the product due to lightning and power-line surges.
17. Power Lines – An outside antenna system should not be located in the vicinity of overhead power lines or other electric light or power circuits, or where it can fall into such power lines or circuits. When installing an outside antenna system, extreme care should be taken to keep from touching such power lines or circuits as contact with them might be fatal.
18. Overloading – Do not overload wall outlets, extension cords, or integral convenience receptacles as this can result in a risk of fire or electric shock.
19. Object and Liquid Entry – Never push objects of any kind into this product through openings as they may touch dangerous voltage points or short-out parts that could result in a fire or electric shock. Never spill liquid of any kind on the product.
20. Ser vicing – Do not attempt to service this product yourself as opening or removing covers may expose you to dangerous voltage or other hazards. Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel.
21. Damage Requiring Service – Unplug this product from the wall outlet and refer servicing to qualified service personnel under the following conditions:
a) When the power-supply cord or plug is damaged, b) If liquid has been spilled, or objects have fallen into the product, c) If the product has been exposed to rain or water, d) If the product does not operate normally by following the operating
instructions. Adjust only those controls that are covered by the operating instructions as an improper adjustment of other controls may result in damage and will often require extensive work by a qualified technician to
restore the product to its normal operation, e) If the product has been dropped or damaged in any way, and f) When the product exhibits a distinct change in performance – this
indicates a need for service.
22. Replacement Parts – When replacement parts are required, be sure the
service technician has used replacement parts specified by the manufacturer or have the same characteristics as the original part. Unauthorized substitutions may result in fire, electric shock, or other hazards.
23. Safety Check – Upon completion of any service or repairs to this product,
ask the service technician to perform safety checks to determine that the product is in proper operating condition.
24. Wall or Ceiling Mounting – The product should be mounted to a wall or
ceiling only as recommended by the manufacturer.
25. Heat – The product should be situated away from heat sources such as
radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other products (including amplifiers) that produce heat.
FIGURE A
EXAMPL E OF ANTENN A GROUNDING
AS PER NATIONAL ELECTR ICAL CODE
"/5&//"
-&"%*/ 8*3&
(306/% $-".1
&-&$53* $ 4&37*$& &26*1.& /5
"/5&//" %*4$)"3 (&6/*5 /&$4&$5 *0/ 
(306/%* /($0/%6$ 5034 /&$4&$5 *0/ 
(306/%$- ".14
108&34&3 7*$&(306 /%*/( &-&$530 %&4:45&. /&$"35 1"35)
/&$/"5*0 /"-&-&$5 3*$"-$0% &
I
Page 3
• Avoid high temperatures. Allow for sufficient heat dispersion when installed in a rack.
• Eviter des températures élevées.
Tenir compte d’une dispersion de chaleur
suffisante lors de l’installation sur une étagère.
• Handle the power cord carefully.
Hold the plug when unplugging the cord.
• Manipuler le cordon d’alimentation avec précaution.
Tenir la prise lors du débranchement du
cordon.
• Keep the unit free from moisture, water, and dust.
• Protéger l’appareil contre l’humidité, l’eau et la poussière.
• Unplug the power cord when not using the unit for long periods of time.
• Débrancher le cordon d’alimentation lorsque l’appareil n’est pas utilisé pendant de longues périodes.
* (For apparatuses with ventilation holes)
• Do not obstruct the ventilation holes.
• Ne pas obstruer les trous d’aération.
• Do not let foreign objects into the unit.
• Ne pas laisser des objets étrangers dans l’appareil.
• Do not let insecticides, benzene, and thinner come in contact with the unit.
• Ne pas mettre en contact des insecticides, du benzène et un diluant avec l’appareil.
• Never disassemble or modify the unit in any way.
• Ne jamais démonter ou modifier l’appareil d’une manière ou d’une autre.
n
NOTE ON USE / OBSERVATIONS RELATIVES A L’UTILISATION
II
FCC INFORMATION (For US customers)
1. PRODUCT
This product complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this
product may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this product must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
2. IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS PRODUCT
This product, when installed as indicated in the instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC requirements.
Modification not expressly approved by DENON may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to use the product.
3. NOTE
This product has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15
of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation.
This product generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance
with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this product does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the product OFF and ON, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:
• Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
• Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
• Connect the product into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.
• Consult the local retailer authorized to distribute this type of product or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003. Cet appareil numérique de la classe B est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada.
Page 4
Accessories ······················································································2 Cautions on Handling ····································································· 3 Cautions on Installation ·································································3 About the Remote Control Unit ····················································3
Inserting the Batteries ····································································3 Operating Range of the Remote Control Unit ································ 3
Part Names and Functions ·····························································4
Front Panel ····················································································· 4 Display ···························································································4 Rear Panel ······················································································5 Remote Control Unit ······································································ 6
Getting Started
Preparations ····················································································7
Cables Used for Connections ························································7 Video Conversion Function ····························································· 8 On-Screen Display for Component Video Outputs and HDMI Output ·················································································8
Speaker Connections ·····································································9
Speaker Installation ········································································9 Speaker Connections ······························································· 9, 10
Connecting Equipment with HDMI connectors ························· 11 Connecting the Monitor ······························································· 12 Connecting the Playback Components ······································ 12
DVD Player ··················································································· 12 Record Player ··············································································· 13 CD Player ····················································································· 13 iPod® ···························································································· 14 TV/CABLE Tuner ··········································································· 14 Satellite Receiver ········································································· 15
Connecting the Recording Components ···································· 15
Digital Video Recorder ·································································· 15 Video Cassette Recorder ····························································· 16 CD Recorder / MD Recorder / Tape Deck ····································· 16
Connections to Other Devices ····················································· 17
Video Camera / Game Console ···················································· 17 Component with Multi-channel Output connectors ····················· 17 External Power Amplifier ······························································ 17 XM connector ··············································································18 Antenna terminals ······································································· 18 Multi-zone ···················································································· 19 External Controller ·······································································19
Connecting the Power Cord·························································20 Once Connections are Completed ··············································20
Connections
Preparations ··················································································23 Auto Setup ····················································································24
a Start Menu ·············································································· 24 Error Messages ······································································· 25 s
Option ····················································································· 25
d
Parameter Check ·····································································25
Auto Setup
Settings Related to Playing Input Sources ································· 34
Auto Preset ·················································································· 34 Preset Skip ···················································································34 Preset Name ················································································ 34 Input Mode ··················································································34 Rename ························································································ 34 Assign ··························································································35 iPod ························································································ 35, 36 Other ····························································································36 Antenna Aiming ···········································································36
Input Setup
Contents
Speaker Setup···············································································26
a Speaker Configuration ·····························································26 s Subwoofer Setup ···································································· 26 d Distance ············································································ 26, 27 f Channel Level··········································································27 g Crossover Frequency ······························································ 27
HDMI Setup ···················································································27
a HDMI Audio Setup ··································································27 s HDMI Video Setup ·································································· 28
Audio Setup ··················································································28
a EXT. IN Subwoofer Level ························································· 28 s 2ch Direct/Stereo ······························································ 28, 29 d Dolby Digital Setup ·································································29 f Auto Surround Mode ······························································29 g Manual EQ ··············································································29
Zone Setup ····················································································30
a ZONE2 Setup ·········································································· 30 s ZONE3 Setup ·········································································· 30
Option Setup ················································································· 31
a Amp Assign ·············································································31 s Volume Control ·······································································31 d Source Delete ·········································································31 f On-Screen Display ····························································31, 32 g Quick Select Name ·································································32 h Trigger Out ··············································································32 j Remote ID Setup ····································································32 k 2Way Remote ········································································· 32 l Display ····················································································32 A0 Setup Lock ·············································································· 33
Manual Setup
Operations ····················································································· 20 Example of Display of Default Values ········································· 21 Examples of On-screen Display and Front Display ····················21 Menu Map ·····················································································22
Menu Operations
a Surround Parameter ··························································38 ~ 40 s Tone Control ·············································································· 40 d Room EQ ··················································································· 40 f RESTORER ················································································ 41 g Night Mode ··············································································· 41 h Audio Delay ···············································································41
Parameter
Standard Playback ········································································ 36
Surround Playback of 2-channel Sources ·······························36, 37 Playing Multi-channel Sources (Dolby Digital, DTS, etc.) ·············37
DSP Simulation Playback·····························································37 Stereo Playback ············································································37 Direct Playback ·············································································37
Playback in the PURE DIRECT Mode ··········································· 38
Surround Modes
Status ····························································································41
a Main zone ···············································································41 s ZONE2 / ZONE3 ······································································41
Audio Input Signal ········································································ 42 HDMI Information ·········································································42
a HDMI Signal Information ························································42 s HDMI Monitor Information ·····················································42
Auto Surround Mode ···································································· 42 Quick Select ··················································································42 Preset Station ···············································································42
Information
Page 5
Check that the following parts are supplied with the product.
q Owner’s manual ...................................................................... 1
w Warranty (for North America model only) ................................ 1
e Service station list ...................................................................1
r Power cord (Cord length: Approx. 7-31/64 ft /1.9 m) ................ 1
t Main remote control (RC-1068) ............................................... 1
y LR6/AA batteries (for RC-1068) ................................................ 2
u Sub remote control (RC-1071) ................................................. 1
i R03/AAA batteries (for RC-1071) .............................................2
o FM indoor antenna ..................................................................1
Q0 AM loop antenna ..................................................................... 1
Q1 Setup microphone (Cord length: Approx. 25 ft / 7.6 m) ............ 1
r t u
Q1
o
Q0
Thank you for purchasing this DENON product. To ensure proper operation, please read these owner’s manual carefully before using the product. After reading them, be sure to keep them for future reference.
Getting Started
Accessories
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Preparations ··················································································43
Turning the Power On ··································································43 Selecting the input source ···························································43 Operations During Playback ·························································43
Playing Video and Audio Equipment ···········································44
Basic Operation ············································································ 44
Listening to FM/AM Broadcasts ·················································44
Basic Operation ············································································ 44 Presetting Radio Stations (Preset Memory) ································· 44 Listening to Preset Stations ·························································44
Listening to XM Satellite Radio Programs ·································45
Basic Operation ············································································ 45 Checking the XM Signal Strength and Radio ID ··························· 46 Searching Categories ··································································· 46 Accessing XM Radio Stations Directly ·········································46
iPod® Playback ············································································· 47
Basic Operation ············································································ 47 Listening to Music ··································································47, 48 Viewing Still Pictures or Videos on the iPod ································· 48
Playback
Main Remote Control Unit···························································51
Operating DENON Audio Components ········································ 51 Presetting ····················································································· 51 Operating Preset Components ············································51 ~ 53 Setting the Remote ID ································································· 54 Learning Function ·········································································54 System Call Function ···································································· 55 Punch Through Function ·······························································55 Setting the Time the Backlight Stays Lit ······································· 55 Adjusting the Backlight’s Brightness ············································56 Resetting the Main Remote Control Unit ·····································56
Sub Remote Control Unit ····························································56
Remote Control Unit Operations
Multi-zone Settings with the Amp Assign Function ·········57 ~ 59 Multi-zone Settings and Operations with Zone Pre-out Output ···· 59 Multi-zone Operations ·································································60
Turning the Power On and Off······················································60 Selecting the Input Source ··························································· 60 Adjusting the Volume ··································································· 60 Turning off the Sound Temporarily ················································60
Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations
Troubleshooting ···································································70 ~ 72
Specifications ··············································································· 73
Other Information ································································ 61 ~ 69
Other Operations ··········································································48
Playing Super Audio CD ······························································· 48 Recording on an External Device (REC OUT mode) ·····················49
Convenient Functions ··································································50
Channel Level ···············································································50 Fader Function ·············································································50 Quick Select Function ··································································50 Personal Memory Plus Function ·················································· 50 Last Function Memory ·································································50 Backup Memory ··········································································· 50 Resetting the Microprocessor ······················································50
Other Operations and Functions
List of preset codes ··········································· End of this manual
Page 6
In addition to the AVR-2808CI, the included main remote control unit (RC-1068) can also be used to operate the equipment listed below.
q DENON system components w Non-DENON system components
By setting the preset memory (vpage 51 ~ 53)
By using the learn function (vpage 54)
q Lift the clasp and remove the rear lid.
e Put the rear cover back on.
(RC-1068) (RC-1071)
(RC-1068) (RC-1071)
LR6/AA
R03/AAA
30°
30°
Approx. 23 feet / 7 m
or
(RC-1068)
(RC-1071)
w Load the two batteries properly as indicated by the marks in the
battery compartment.
About the Remote Control Unit
Inserting the Batteries
NOTE
• Replace the batteries with new ones if the set does not operate even when the remote control unit is operated close to the unit.
• The supplied batteries are only for verifying operation.
• When inserting the batteries, be sure to do so in the proper direction, following the “q” and “w” marks in the battery compartment.
• To prevent damage or leakage of battery fluid:
• Do not use a new battery together with an old one.
• Do not use two different types of batteries.
• Do not attempt to charge dry batteries.
• Do not short-circuit, disassemble, heat or dispose of batteries in
flames.
• If the battery fluid should leak, carefully wipe the fluid off the inside of the battery compartment and insert new batteries.
• Remove the batteries from the remote control unit if it will not be in use for long periods.
• When replacing the batteries, have the new batteries ready and insert them as quickly as possible.
Operating Range of the Remote Control Unit
Point the remote control unit at the remote sensor when operating it.
NOTE
The set may function improperly or the remote control unit may not operate if the remote control sensor is exposed to direct sunlight, strong artificial light from an inverter type fluorescent lamp or infrared light.
• Before turning the power switch on
Check once again that all connections are correct and that there are
no problems with the connection cables.
Power is supplied to some of the circuitry even when the unit is set to the standby mode. When traveling or leaving home for long periods of time, be sure to unplug the power cord from the power outlet.
• About condensation
If there is a major difference in temperature between the inside of
the unit and the surroundings, condensation (dew) may form on the operating parts inside the unit, causing the unit not to operate properly.
If this happens, let the unit sit for an hour or two with the power
turned off and wait until there is little difference in temperature before using the unit.
• Cautions on using mobile phones
Using a mobile phone near this unit may result in noise. If so, move
the mobile phone away from this unit when it is in use.
• Moving the unit
Turn off the power and unplug the power cord from the power
outlet.
Next, disconnect the connection cables to other system units before
moving the unit.
Note that the illustrations in these instructions may differ from the actual unit for explanation purposes.
Note: For proper heat dispersal, do not install this unit in a confined space, such as a bookcase or similar enclosure.
b Note
b
Wall
b
b
Cautions on Handling
Cautions on Installation
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 7
For buttons not explained here, see the page indicated in parentheses ( ).
q w e r
to i u y
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
q Power operation button
(ON/STANDBY) ···········································(43)
w Power indicator ··········································· (43) e Power switch (hON jOFF) ····················· (43) r QUICK SELECT buttons / indicators ········· (50) t MASTER VOLUME control knob ················ (43) y Master volume indicator u Display i Remote control sensor ································· (3) o SOURCE SELECT knob······························· (43) Q0 SOURCE button ·········································· (43) Q1 TUNING PRESET button ···························· (44) Q2 ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT button ··········(49, 60) Q3 VIDEO SELECT button ·······························(35)
Q4 Headphones jack (PHONES) ······················ (43) Q5 ZONE2 ON/OFF button ······························ (60) Q6 ZONE3 ON/OFF button ······························ (60) Q7 INPUT MODE button ·································· (34) Q8 MENU button ·············································· (20) Q9 Cursor buttons (uio p) ·························· (20) W0 CH SEL / ENTER button ······················· (20, 50) W1 RETURN button ·········································· (20) W2 V.AUX INPUT connectors ··························· (17) W3 SETUP MIC jack ·········································· (23) W4 ROOM EQ button ········································ (40) W5 DIMMER button ·········································· (32) W6 SPEAKER button ········································· (43) W7 SURROUND BACK button ························· (40) W8 STATUS button ···········································(42) W9 AUDIO DELAY button ································· (41) E0 RESTORER button ······································ (41) E1 DIRECT/STEREO button·····························(37) E2 PURE DIRECT button ·································· (38) E3 DSP SIMULATION button ·························· (37) E4 STANDARD button ·····································(36)
t
u yQ6Q7 iQ0
oQ1
Q2Q3Q4Q5
wq e r
q Input signal indicators w Input signal channel indicators
These light when digital signals are input.
e Information display
The input source name, surround mode, setting
values and other information are displayed here.
r Output signal channel indicators t Front speaker indicator
These light according to the settings of the front
A and B speakers.
y HDMI monitor indicator
This lights when an HDMI monitor is detected.
u Master volume indicator i AUDYSSEY MULTEQ XT indicator
This lights when the room equalizer is selected.
o Recording output source indicator
This lights when the REC OUT mode is
selected.
Q0 NIGHT indicator
This lights when the night mode is selected.
Q1 Multi-zone indicators
These light when the power for the respective
zone is turned on.
Q2 RESTORER indicator
This lights when the RESTORER mode is
selected.
Q3 AL24 indicator
This lights when AL24 Processing Plus is
activated (vpage 63).
Q4 Input mode indicators Q5 HDMI indicator
This lights when playing using HDMI
connections.
Q6 Decoder indicators
These light when the respective decoders are
operating.
Q7 Tuner reception mode indicators
These light according to the reception conditions
when the input source is set to “TUNER”.
AUTO
This lights when in the auto tuning mode.
STEREO
In the FM mode, this lights when receiving analog stereo broadcasts.
TUNED
This lights when the broadcast is properly tuned in.
Part Names and Functions
Front Panel
Display
Q4
E4 E3 E2 E1 E0 W9 W8 W7 W6 W5 W4 W3
Q5 Q6 Q7 Q8 Q9 W0 W1 W2
GWith the door openH
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 8
q w
Q4 Q5
e r t y
Q4
u i
oQ0Q1Q2Q3
Q6 Q7 Q6
q RS-232C connector ····································· (19) w REMOTE CONTROL jacks··························· (19) e TRIGGER OUT jacks ··································· (19) r DOCK CONTROL jack ································· (14) t Speaker terminals (SPEAKERS) ·················· (9) y SIGNAL GND terminal ······························· (13) u AC inlet (AC IN) ··········································· (20)
i AC OUTLETS ··············································· (20) o Digital audio connectors
(OPTICAL / COAXIAL) ·························· (12, 15)
Q0 COMPONENT VIDEO connectors ·············· (12) Q1 XM connector (SAT TU) ······························ (18) Q2 HDMI connectors ·········································(11) Q3 VIDEO / S-VIDEO connectors ···················· (12)
Q4 Analog audio connectors (AUDIO) ············ (12) Q5 FM/AM antenna terminals
(TUNER ANTENNA) ···································· (18)
Q6 PRE OUT connectors ····························· (17, 19) Q7 EXT. IN connectors ····································· (17)
Rear Panel
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 9
q
i
w
e
r
t y u
o
Q1
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q0
Q5
Q6 Q7
Q9
W0
W2
W5
W7
W6
W4
W3
W1
Q8
q Signal transmission indicator ···················(51) w Mode select buttons ··································(51) e Quick select / System call buttons ·····(50, 55) r Surround mode buttons ····················(36 ~ 38) t System buttons ···································· (52, 53) y Audio delay button (A. DL) ························(41) u Tuner system buttons ································ (44) i Input mode button (INPUT) ······················· (34) o MENU button ·············································· (20) Q0 Cursor buttons (uio p) ························· (20) Q1 Parameter / Search button
(PARA / SRCH) ································ (38, 46, 48)
Q2 HOME button ·············································· (51) Q3 Channel buttons (CH) ································· (44) Q4 Input source select / Number buttons ·· (43, 44) Q5 Remote control signal transmitter ·············· (3) Q6 Device select indicators (DEV1 / DEV2) ···(51) Q7 ZONE3 select indicators (Z3) ····················· (51) Q8 RESTORER button (RSTR) ·························· (41) Q9 Night button (NGT) ···································· (41) W0 Test tone button (TEST) ····························· (27) W1 Front speaker select button (SPKR) ·········· (43) W2 POWER buttons ·········································· (43) W3 Channel select (CH SEL) /
ENTER button ······································· (20, 50)
W4 Return button (RTN) ··································· (20) W5 Master volume control buttons (VOL) ······(43) W6 Muting button (MUTE) ························· (43, 60) W7 Main remote control unit setup button
(RC SETUP) ················································· (51)
q
i
o
Q0
Q1
Q2 Q3
Q4
w
e
r
t
y
u
q Remote control signal transmitter ·············· (3) w Zone power off button (OFF) ····················· (60) e CHANNEL buttons ······································ (56) r TUNING buttons ········································· (56) t System buttons ·········································· (56) y REPEAT button ············································ (56) u RANDOM button ········································(56) i ZONE2/ZONE3 select switch ····················· (56) o Zone power on button (ON) ······················ (60) Q0 Input source select buttons ······················· (60) Q1 Volume control buttons (VOLUME) ··········(60) Q2 Muting button (MUTE) ······························· (60) Q3 SHIFT button ··············································· (56) Q4 FAVORITES DIRECT PLAY button ·············· (56)
n Main remote control unit (RC-1068) n Sub remote control unit (RC-1071)
The time for which the backlight stays on can be changed (vpage 55 “Setting the Time the Backlight Stays Lit”).
Remote Control Unit
NOTE
• The M. SEL, DTU, NET/USB buttons cannot be
used.
• The NET/DTU and ZONE2 mode QUICK SELECT (1
~ 3), A. DL, RSTR, NGT, INPUT, SPKR, TEST and
surround mode buttons cannot be used.
• The ZONE4 mode cannot be used.
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 10
Audio cables Video cables
Coaxial digital connections
(Orange)
Coaxial digital (75 Ω/ohms pin-plug) cable
Optical digital connections
Optical cable
Analog connections (stereo)
(White)
(Red)
R
L
R
L
Stereo pin-plug cable
Analog connections (monaural, for subwoofer)
(Black)
Pin-plug cable
Speaker connections
Speaker cables
Component video connections
(Green)
(Blue)
(Red)
(Y)
(PB/CB)
(PR/CR)
Component video cable
S-Video connections
S-Video cable
Video connections
(Yellow)
75 Ω/ohms pin-plug video cable
Audio and video cables
HDMI connections
19-pin HDMI cable
Signal direction
Audio signal: Video signal:
Output
Input
Input
Output
Output
Input
Input
Output
Connections
NOTE
• Do not plug in the power cord until all connections have been completed.
• When making connections, also refer to the operating instructions of the other components.
• Be sure to connect the left and right channels properly (left with left, right with right).
• Do not bundle power cords together with connection cables. Doing so can result in humming or noise.
Connections for all compatible audio and video signal formats are described in these operating instructions. Please select the types of connections suited for the equipment you are connecting. With some types of connections, certain settings must be made on the AVR-2808CI. For details, refer to the instructions for the respective connection items below.
Cables Used for Connections
Select the cables according to the equipment being connected.
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Preparations
Page 11
GFlow of video signals for ZONE2H
• This function automatically converts various formats of video signals input to the AVR-2808CI into the format used to output the video signals from the AVR-2808CI to a monitor.
• The AVR-2808CI’s video input/output circuitry is compatible with the following four types of video signals: Digital video signals: HDMI Analog video signals: Component video, S-Video and Video
Video Conversion Function
GFlow of video signals inside the AVR-2808CIH
Main zone
High picture
quality playback
HDMI connector
Component video
connectors
S-Video connector
Video connector
Monitor
HDMI connector
Component video
connectors
S-Video connector
Video connector
Video inputs Video outputs
: When 480i/576i signals are input in the main zone
S-Video connector
Video connector Video connector
Video inputs Video outputs
ZONE2
NOTE
• HDMI signals cannot be converted into analog signals.
• 1080p component input video signals cannot be output to anything other than component video connectors.
• 480p/576p, 1080i and 720p component video input signals cannot be converted into S-Video or Video format.
• When a non-standard video signal from a game machine or some other source is input, the video conversion function might not operate.
• When not using this function, connect a monitor output with the same type of connector as the video input connector.
• The resolution of the HDMI input-compatible monitor connected to the AVR-2808CI can be checked at menu “Information” – “HDMI Signal Information” – “HDMI Monitor Information” (vpage 42).
High picture
quality playback
ZONE2
monitor
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
• When viewing HDMI or component video signals via the AVR-2808CI, the on-screen display appears when the MENU button or the main remote control unit´s PARA button is operated.
• When only HDMI or component video signals are input to the AVR-2808CI, the characters of the on­screen display are not displayed over the picture.
On-Screen Display for Component Video Outputs and HDMI Output
Page 12
Speaker Connections
w qw q
(R) (L)
w qw q
(R) (L)
w q
w q w q
(L) (R)
*/
w q w q
(L) (R)
The illustration below shows a basic example of installation of the amplifier combined with 8 speakers and a monitor.
Speaker Installation
Subwoofer Center speaker
Surround speakers
Front speakers
Place the front speakers to the sides of the monitor or screen and as flush with the screen surface as possible.
The table below shows a typical speaker configuration for the AVR-2808CI.
Surround back speakers
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND SURROUND BACK
SUBWOOFER
L R L R L R 1 only
7.1-channels
(FRONT A+B)
S S S S S S S
S
7.1-channels
S S S S S S S
S
6.1-channels
S S S S S
S S
5.1-channels
S S S S S
S
3.1-channels
S S S
S
2.1-channels
S S
S
2-channels
S S
Speaker Connections
Example: 5.1-channels (FRONT A+B) and ZONE2 use
Front speakers
A
Center speaker Subwoofer
Subwoofer with built-in amplifier
Surround speakers ZONE2 speakers
ZONE2
When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the left channel (SBL).
NOTE
By default, the AVR-2808CI’s “Amp Assign” setting is set to “ZONE2”. To use as the surround back speaker for the main zone, change the “Amp Assign” setting (vpage 31).
b L : Left R : Right
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Front speakers
B
Page 13
Connecting the Speaker Cables
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and + (red) and – (black) polarities on the speakers being connected to the AVR-2808CI, and be sure to interconnect the channels and polarities correctly.
1
Peel off about 0.03 ft/10 mm of sheathing
from the tip of the speaker cable, then either twist the core wire tightly or terminate it.
2
Turn the speaker terminal
counterclockwise to loosen it.
3
Insert the speaker cable’s core wire to
the hilt into the speaker terminal.
4
Turn the speaker terminal clockwise to
tighten it.
When using a banana plug
Tighten the speaker terminal firmly before inserting the banana plug.
NOTE
• Use speakers with an impedance of 6 to 16 Ω/ohms. When using front A and B speakers simultaneously, use speakers with an impedance of 8 to 16 Ω/ohms.
• Connect the speaker cables in such a way that they do not stick out of the speaker terminals. The protection circuit may be activated if the core wires touch the rear panel or if the + and – sides touch each other (v “Protection circuit”).
• Never touch the speaker terminals while the power supply is connected. Doing so could result in electric shock.
Protection circuit
If speakers with an impedance lower than specified (for example 4 Ω/ohms speakers) are used for an extended period of time with the volume turned up high, the temperature may rise, activating the protection circuit. When the protection circuit is activated, the speaker output is shut off and the power indicator flashes red. If this happens, unplug the power cord, then check the speaker cable and input cable connections. If the set is extremely hot, wait for it to cool off and improve ventilation around it. Once this is done, plug the power cord back in and turn the set's power back on. If the protection circuit is activated again even though there are no problems in the ventilation around the set nor in the connections, the set may be damaged. Turn the power off, then contact a DENON service center.
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 14

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
With HDMI connections, the video and audio signals can be transferred with a single cable.
*/
)%.*
065
)%.*
Compatible
audio format
Details
Discs
(examples)
2-channel linear PCM
2ch 32-192 kHz 16/20/24 bits
CD, DVD-Video, DVD-Audio
Multi-channel linear PCM
8ch 32-192 kHz 16/20/24 bits
DVD-Audio
Dolby Digital, DTS Bitstream DVD-Video
DSD
2/5.1ch
2.8224 MHz 1 bit
SACD
Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD, DTS-HD
Bitstream
HD DVD, Blu-ray Disc
MonitorDVD player
b The AVR-2808CI is equipped for HDMI version 1.3a.
This version is compatible with other versions, allowing connection to all components equipped with an HDMI connector.
b The AVR-2808CI is compatible with 30- and 36-bit Deep
Color.
Copyright protection system (HDCP)
In order to play the digital video and audio signals of a DVD­Video or DVD-Audio disc using HDMI/DVI connections, both the connected DVD player and monitor must be equipped for a copyright protection system called “HDCP” (High­bandwidth Digital Content Protection). HDCP is a copy protection technology consisting of data encoding and mutual identification of the devices. The AVR-2808CI is HDCP-compatible. For details on the DVD player or monitor you are using, refer to its operating instructions.
• When the AVR-2808CI and DVD player are connected using an HDMI cable, also connect the AVR-2808CI and monitor using an HDMI cable.
• If the connected monitor or DVD player only has a DVI-D connector, use an HDMI/DVI converter cable. When using a DVI cable, no audio signals are transmitted.
• Use a Deep Color compatible cable for connection to Deep Color compatible devices.
When connecting with an HDMI/DVI converter cable (adapter)
• HDMI video signals are theoretically compatible with the DVI format. When connecting to a monitor, etc., equipped with a DVI-D connector, connection is possible using an
HDMI/DVI converter cable, but depending on the combination of components in some cases the video signals will not be output.
• When connecting using an HDMI/DVI converter adapter, the video signals may not be output properly due to poor connections with the connected cable, etc.
• By default, the HDMI audio signals are output from the speakers connected to the AVR-2808CI.
• To output the sound from the TV, make the settings at menu “Manual Setup” – “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI
Audio Setup” – “TV” (vpage 27).
NOTE
• Use a CPPM-compatible DVD player to play DVD-Audio discs that are copyright-protected by CPPM.
• The AVR-2808CI cannot be controlled from another device via the HDMI cable.
• The audio signals output from the HDMI connector (sampling frequency, bit rate, etc.) may be restricted by the connected device.
• Video signals are not output properly when using devices that are not HDCP-compatible.
• Video signals are not output if the input video signals do not match the monitor’s resolution. In this case, switch the DVD player’s resolution to a resolution with which the monitor is compatible.
• If the menu “Manual Setup” – “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup” setting (vpage 27) is set to “AMP”, the sound may be interrupted when the monitor’s power is turned off.
• Use a cable on which the HDMI logo is indicated (a certified HDMI product) for connection to the HDMI connector. Normal playback may not be possible when using a cable other than one on which the HDMI logo is indicated (a non-HDMI-certified product).
• If the monitor or DVD player does not support deep color, deep color signal transfer is not possible.
• If the monitor or DVD player does not support xvYCC, xvYCC signal transfer is not possible.
• If the monitor does not support “Auto Lipsync Correction” function, this function will not work.
Connecting Equipment with HDMI connectors
Page 15

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
• Connect the cables to be used (vpage 8 “Video Conversion Function”).
• With HDMI connections, the video and audio signals can be transferred with a single cable.
• To output the audio signals to the monitor with HDMI connections, set menu “Manual Setup” – “HDMI
Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup” to “TV” (vpage 27).
Connecting the Monitor
47*%&0
*/
7*%&0
$0.10/&/57*%&0
: 1# 13
7*%&0
*/
)%.*
*/ */
R
L
R
L
47*%&0
065
"6%*07*%&0
$0.10/&/57*%&0
: 1# 13
7*%&0
065 065
"6%*0
$0"9*"-
065
3-
065065
)%.*
Monitor
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and the inputs and outputs, and be sure to interconnect correctly.
Connecting the Playback Components
DVD Player
• Connect the cables to be used.
• With HDMI connections, the video and audio signals can be transferred with a single cable.
DVD player
NOTE
• The component video connectors may be indicated differently on your monitor. For details, see the monitor’s operating instructions.
• The audio signals output from the HDMI connectors are only the HDMI input signals.
• Connect an HDP (High-Definition Player) in the same way.
• When using an optical cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup”
– “Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage 35).
Page 16
Record Player
• When connecting a record player with an MC cartridge, use a commercially available MC head amplifier or a step-up transformer.
• Induction humming (a booming sound) may be produced from the speakers if the volume is raised with no record player connected.
• With some record players, noise may be generated when the ground wire is connected. If so, disconnect the ground wire.
(/%
"6%*0
065
R
L
Turntable (MM cartridge)
NOTE
The AVR-2808CI’s SIGNAL GND terminal is meant to reduce noise when a record player is connected. This is not a safety ground terminal.
R
L
R
L
"6%*0
"6%*0
$0"9*"-
065
3-
065
CD Player
Connect the cables to be used.
CD player
When using an optical cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage
35).
ConnectionsGetting Started Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 17

47*%&0
065
"6%*07*%&0
$0.10/&/57*%&0
: 1# 13
7*%&0
065 065
"6%*0
3-
065
$0"9*"-
065
R
L
R
L
TV/CABLE Tuner
Connect the cables to be used.
TV tuner
When using an optical cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage 35).
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
iPod
®
R
L
R
L
"4%3
iPod
• With the default settings, the iPod can be used connected to the VCR (iPod) connector.
• To assign the iPod to a connector other than VCR (iPod), make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “(input source to which iPod dock assigned)” – “Assign” – “iPod dock” (vpage 36).
Use a DENON Control Dock for iPod (ASD-1R, sold separately) to connect the iPod to the AVR-2808CI. For instructions on the Control Dock for iPod settings, refer to the Control Dock for iPod’s operating instructions.
Page 18
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and the inputs and outputs, and be sure to interconnect correctly.
Connecting the Recording Components
Digital Video Recorder
Connect the cables to be used.
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
47*%&0
*/
3- 3-
*/*/065
"6%*07*%&0
*/065
015*$"-
065
"6%*07*%&0
065
Digital video recorder
NOTE
Do not connect the output of the component connected to the AVR-2808CI’s OPTICAL2 output connector to any input connector other than OPTICAL2.
• Make analog connections if you wish to record analog audio signals.
• When recording via the AVR-2808CI, the playback device´s cable must be of the same type as the cable used to connect the AVR-2808CI´s DVR OUT connector. Example: TV IN S-Video cable : DVR OUT S-Video cable TV IN Video cable : DVR OUT Video cable
• When using a component video cable for the video connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Assign” – “Component In” (vpage 36).
or or

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Satellite Receiver
Connect the cables to be used.
R
L
R
L
47*%&0
065
"6%*07*%&0
7*%&0
065 065
015*$"-"6%*0
3-
065
DBS / BS tuner
• When using a coaxial digital cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input
Setup” – “Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage 35).
• When using a component video cable for the video connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup”
– “Assign” – “Component In” (vpage 36).
Page 19
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
3- 3-
065 */065
015*$"-
*/
"6%*0
"6%*0
CD Recorder / MD Recorder / Tape Deck
Make analog connections if you wish to record analog audio signals, or digital connections if you wish to record digital audio signals, depending on the types of connectors on the components being used.
CD recorder / MD recorder / Tape deck
NOTE
Do not connect the output of the component connected to the AVR-2808CI’s OPTICAL3 output connector to any input connector other than OPTICAL3.
or

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
47*%&0
*/
3- 3-
*/*/065
"6%*07*%&0
*/065
015*$"-
065
"6%*07*%&0
065
Video Cassette Recorder
Connect the cables to be used.
Video cassette recorder
• When recording via the AVR-2808CI, the playback device´s cable must be of the same type as the cable used to connect the AVR-2808CI´s VCR OUT connector. Example: TV IN S-Video cable : VCR OUT S-Video cable TV IN Video cable : VCR OUT Video cable
• When using a component video cable for the video connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Assign” – “Component In” (vpage 36).
or
NOTE
Do not connect the output of the component connected to the AVR-2808CI’s OPTICAL3 output connector to any input connector other than OPTICAL3.
or
Page 20

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
R
L
R
L
47*%&0
065
"6%*07*%&0
7*%&0
065 065
015*$"-"6%*0
3-
065
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
46#
800'&3
$&/5&3 463306/%
#"$,
3-
463306/%
3-
'30/5
3-
"6%*0
Video Camera / Game Console
Video camera / Game console
Component with Multi-channel Output connectors
DVD player / Super Audio CD player / External decoder
• To play the analog input signals input to the EXT. IN connectors, press
the INPUT MODE button on the main unit or INPUT button on the main remote control unit and select “EXT. IN” or make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Input Mode” – “Input Mode” – “EXT. IN” (vpage 34).
• The video signal can be connected in the same way as a DVD player
(vpage 12).
• To play copyright-protected discs, connect the AVR-2808CI’s EXT. IN connector with the DVD player’s analog multi-channel output connector.
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
46#
800'&3
$&/5&3 463306/%
#"$,
3-
463306/%
3-
'30/5
3-
"6%*0
External Power Amplifier
When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the left channel (SBL).
Power amplifier
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and the inputs and outputs, and be sure to interconnect correctly.
Connections to Other Devices
Page 21
XM
NOTE
Keep the power cord unplugged until the XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock connection have been completed.
XM connector
• The AVR-2808CI is an XM Ready® receiver. You can receive XM® Satellite Radio by connecting to the XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock (includes home antenna, sold separately) and subscribing to the XM service.
• Plug the XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock into the XM connector on the rear panel.
• Position the Home Dock antenna near a south-facing window to receive the best signal.
For details, see “Listening to XM Satellite Radio Programs” (vpage
45, 46).
When making connections, also refer to the operating instructions of
the XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock.
XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock
• The XM name and related logo are registered trademarks of XM
Satellite Radio Inc. All rights reserved.
• XM Ready is a registered trademark of XM Satellite Radio Inc. All
rights reserved.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Antenna terminals
An F-type FM antenna cable plug can be connected directly.
Direction of broadcasting station
AM loop antenna (supplied)
FM antenna
75 Ω/ohms Coaxial cable
FM indoor antenna
(supplied)
Ground
AM outdoor antenna
Note to CATV system installer:
This reminder is provided to call the CATV system installer’s attention to Article 820-40 of the NEC which provides guidelines for proper grounding and, in particular, specifies that the cable ground shall be connected to the grounding system of the building, as close to the point of cable entry as practical.
AM loop antenna assembly
Remove the vinyl tie and take out the connection line.
Connect to the AM antenna terminals.
Bend in the reverse direction.
a. With the antenna on top of
any stable surface.
Mount
b. With the antenna attached
to a wall.
Installation hole Mount on wall, etc.
Connection of AM antennas
1. Push the lever.
2. Insert the conductor.
3. Return the lever.
NOTE
• Do not connect two FM antennas simultaneously.
• Even if an external AM antenna is used, do not disconnect the AM loop antenna.
• Make sure the AM loop antenna lead terminals do not touch metal parts of the panel.
Page 22
Multi-zone
ZONE2 or ZONE3 Pre-out Connections
• If another power amplifier or pre-main (integrated) amplifier is connected, the ZONE2 or ZONE3 pre-out (variable or fixed level) connectors can be used to play a different program source in ZONE2 or ZONE3 the same time (vpage 57 ~ 60).
• When using an S-Video cable or a video cable for connection between the AVR-2808CI and an input device, connect to the video connectors.
• The ZONE2 video out is only for ZONE2.
R
L
R
L
"6%*0
3-
*/*/
7*%&0
"6%*07*%&0
"69 065
Monitor (ZONE2)
Power amplier (ZONE2 or ZONE3)
Input
Output Infrared retransmitter
Infrared sensor
Extension jack for future use.
NOTE
• For the audio output, use high quality pin-plug cords so that no induction humming or noise is produced.
• For instructions on installing and operating separately sold devices, refer to the respective devices’ operating instructions.
• To conduct multi-zone playback, see “Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations” (vpage 57 ~ 60).

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
External Controller
• When using in combination with an RF Remote Controller (RC-7000CI, sold separately) or RF Remote Receiver (RC-7001RCI, sold separately) two-way communication with an RF Remote Controller is possible.
The AVR-2808CI’s status information as well as iPod can be browsed watching the RF Remote Controller’s
display. For details, refer to the operating instructions of the respective devices.
• When used in combination with an RF Remote Controller or RF Remote Receiver, make the settings at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “2Way Remote” – “Used” (vpage 32).
RS-232C connector
This connector is used for an external controller.
b If you wish to control the AVR-2808CI from
an external controller using the RS-232C connector, perform the operation below beforehand.
q Turn om the AVR-2808CI’s power. w Turn off the AVR-2808CI’s power from the
external controller.
e Check that the AVR-2808CI is in the standby
mode.
Trigger output jacks
The power of an external device equipped with a trigger input jack can be turned on and off in association with operations on the AVR-2808CI. For details, see menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Trigger Out” (vpage 32).
• Output: DC 12 V 150 mA MAX. Check the trigger input conditions of the connected device.
Page 23
NOTE
• Insert the AC plugs securely. Incomplete connections could cause noise.
• Only use the AC outlets to plug in audio devices. Do not use them as power supplies for hairdryers or anything other than audio equipment.
Wait until all connections have been completed before connecting the power cord.
To household
power outlet
(AC 120 V, 60 Hz)
Power cord
(included)
Connection to the AC outlets
• These outlets supply power to external audio devices.
• The power supplied from these outlets turns on and off together with the set’s power switch.
• Audio equipment with a total power consumption of 120 W (1 A) can be connected.
Connecting the Power Cord
Turning the Power On (vpage 43)
Once Connections are Completed
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
MENU
uiop
ENTER
RETURN
[ AMP]
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit [ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control
unit
ENTER RETURN
uiop
MENU
1
Press MENU.
The menu is displayed.
b To operate from the main remote control unit,
be sure to set the remote control unit to the AMP mode.
2
Press ui to select the item you want
to set, then press ENTER.
3
Press ui again to select the item you
want to set, then press ENTER.
4
To change the setting:
Press ui to select the item you want
to change, then press o p to change the setting.
b To return to the previous item, press RETURN. b Select “Default Yes”, then press o to reset to
the default setting.
5
Press ENTER to enter the setting.
6
Press MENU to nish.
Menu Operations
With the AVR-2808CI, settings and operations for most functions can be performed by operating while looking at the menus displayed on the monitor screen.
Operations
The same operation is possible on the main unit or remote control unit.
When MENU is pressed, the settings made up to that point are entered and the setting menu is cleared.
Page 24

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Examples of On-screen Display and Front Display
MENU
1.Auto Setup
2.Manual Setup
3.Input Setup
4.Parameter
5.Information
GOn-screen displayHGFront displayH
* ME N U A ut o S e t u p
* St a r t M e n u S ta r t •
* D i s t a n c e U n i t : M e t e r • –F e e t
[Selectable items]
A B A + B
Example of Display of Default Values
In lists of selectable items or adjustable ranges, the item surrounded by a border is the default value.
1-1.Start Menu
Step1:Speaker Detection
at ear height at
Front Sp. A Amp Assign Start Cancel
Please place microphone
main listening position.
Audyssey
MultEQ XT
3-1.Assign
Digital In : OPT1
iPod dock : None
2-1-3.Distance
Set The Distance To
Meters : Feet
Each Speakers
Do You Prefer In Meters? / In Feet?
* As s i g n D ig i t a l : • O PT 1 –
Screen title
Submenu title
Press o to execute
Press op to change the setting
Current setting
Currently selected line
Press op to select one or the other
Some typical examples are described below.
* Re n a m e : D V D R en a m e • – C l ea r
Default
: DV
3-3.Rename
Yes
DVD
Default
: DVD-3930
3-3.Rename
Yes
DVD
* Re n a m e : D V D
• D V ¡ –
Use op to change the character input
position.
Use ui to input characters.
When highlighted, press i to select
“Default Yes”.
Page 25

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Menu Map
MENU
1.Auto Setup
2.Manual Setup
3.Input Setup
4.Parameter
5.Information
Auto Setup
(vpage 23 ~ 25)
n Start Menu
• Step 1: Speaker Detection
• Step 2: Measurement
• Step 3: Calculation
• Step 4: Check
• Step 5: Store
n Option
• Room EQ
• Direct Mode Setup
• Mic Select
n Parameter Check
• Speaker Configuration Check
• Distance Check
• Channel Level Check
• Crossover Frequency Check
• EQ Check
• Restore
Manual Setup
(vpage 26 ~ 33)
n Speaker Setup (vpage 26, 27)
• Speaker Configuration
• Subwoofer Setup
• Distance
• Channel Level
• Crossover Frequency
n HDMI Setup (vpage 27, 28)
• HDMI Audio Setup
· HDMI Audio Out
· Auto Lipsync
• HDMI Video Setup
· i/p Scaler
· Resolution
· Progressive Mode
· Aspect
· Color Space
· RGB Range
n Audio Setup (vpage 28, 29)
• EXT. IN Subwoofer Level
• 2ch Direct/Stereo
• Dolby Digital Setup
• Auto Surround Mode
• Manual EQ
n Zone Setup (vpage 30)
• ZONE2 Setup
· Bass
· Treble
· HPF
· Lch Level
· Rch Level
· Channel
· Volume Level
· Volume Limit
· Power On Level
· Mute Level
• ZONE3 Setup
· Bass
· Treble
· HPF
· Lch Level
· Rch Level
· Channel
· Volume Level
· Volume Limit
· Power On Level
· Mute Level
n Option Setup (vpage 31 ~ 33)
• Amp Assign
• Volume Control
· Volume Limit
· Power On Level
· Mute Level
• Source Delete
• On-Screen Display
· Screensaver
· Text
· Master Volume
· Tuner Information
· iPod Information
· Display Mode
• Quick Select Name
• Trigger Out
• Remote ID Setup
• 2Way Remote
• Display
• Setup Lock
Parameter
(vpage 38 ~ 41)
n Surround Parameter
• MODE
• CINEMA EQ
• D.COMP
• DRC
• LFE
• CENTER IMAGE
• PANORAMA
• DIMENSION
• CENTER WIDTH
• DELAY TIME
• EFFECT
• LEVEL
• ROOM SIZE
• AFDM
• SB CH OUT
• SW ATT
• Subwoofer
• Default
n Tone Control
• Tone Defeat
• Bass
• Treble
n Room EQ n RESTORER n Night Mode n Audio Delay
Information
(vpage 41, 42)
n Status
• MAIN ZONE
• ZONE2/3
n Audio Input Signal n HDMI Information n Auto Surround Mode n Quick Select n Preset Station
Input Setup
(vpage 33 ~ 36)
n TUNER (FM/AM)
• Auto Preset
• Preset Skip
• Preset Name
• Input Mode
• Rename
• Other
· Video Select
· Source Level
n PHONO
• Input Mode
• Rename
• Other
· Video Select
· Source Level
n CD, DVD, HDP, TV/CBL, SAT, VCR, DVR, V.AUX
• Assign
• Input Mode
• Rename
• Other
· Video Select
· Video Convert
(Excluding CDs)
· Source Level
• iPod
n XM
• Preset Skip
• Antenna Aiming
• Input Mode
• Rename
• Other
· Video Select
· Source Level
When “Screensaver” is set to “ON”, the screensaver is activated if no operation is performed for about 3 minutes. When the uiop, ENTER or MENU button is pressed, the screensaver is canceled and the corresponding operation is performed.
Page 26
• Audyssey MultEQ® XT automatically measures the acoustical problems in the listening environment to create the best audio experience for your home theater.
• It optimizes a large listening area where one or more listeners are seated.
Measurements are performed by placing the calibrated microphone
(DM-A405) successively at multiple positions throughout the listening area as shown in Example q. For best results, it is strongly recommended to measure 6 or more positions so that the measurements have the proper spatial weighting.
Even if the listening environment is small as shown in Example w,
measuring at multiple points throughout the listening environment results in more effective correction.
Preparations
When using a subwoofer, make the following settings before starting the auto setup procedure:
• Defeat the volume and crossover controls if possible
• If this is not possible then set
Volume: “12 o’clock” position
Crossover frequency: “Maximum/Highest Frequency”
Low pass filter: “Off”
Standby mode: “Off”
NOTE
• Do not disconnect the setup microphone until the auto setup procedure is completed.
• When using headphones, unplug the headphones before starting the auto setup procedure.
Auto Setup
To make manual adjustments to the settings, see pages 26, 27.
1
Connect the included calibrated setup microphone to
the SETUP MIC jack on the main unit.
The auto setup screen appears automatically.
2
Place the microphone at ear height on a tripod or stand
with the microphone pointing directly up towards the ceiling.
b It is not recommended to hold it in your hand. Be sure that the
path from microphone to the speakers is not blocked by objects. Avoid placing the microphone close to a seat back or wall as sound reflections may give inaccurate results.
Sound receptor
Setup
microphone
About the main listening position (*M)
The main listening position refers to the most central position where one would normally sit within the listening environment. MultEQ XT uses the measurements from this position to calculate speaker distance, level, polarity, and the optimum crossover value for the subwoofer.
*
M
*
M
Example q Example w
( :Measuring positions)

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 27
The speaker connection and polarity are detected at the first measurement position. The following attributes are also determined at this time: “Speaker Size”, “Speaker Distance”, “Channel Level”, “Crossover Frequency”. Once the measurements are completed, the results are displayed.
Step 1 : Speaker Detection
Auto Setup
Optimize settings for speakers in use.
F Menu screen F
1-1.Start Menu
Step1:Speaker Detection
at ear height at
Front Sp. A Amp Assign Start Cancel
Please place microphone
main listening position.
Audyssey
MultEQ XT
Start
Start Auto Setup. The Audyssey MultEQ XT Auto Setup process automatically calculates the size, level, distance, bass management crossover frequency, and optimal settings for each speaker and subwoofer. Audyssey MultEQ XT corrects acoustical distortions within the listening area. Before starting, connect and position all your speakers. Once started, MultEQ XT will play a series of test tones through each speaker.
NOTE
• Loud test tone may be played during Audyssey MultEQ XT Automatic Speaker Setup. This is part of normal operation. If there is background noise in room, these test tones will increase in volume.
• Do not stand between the speakers and setup microphone or allow obstacles in the path while the measurements are being made. This will cause inaccurate readings.
• Quiet the listening environment before beginning measurements and refrain from talking. Turn off air conditioning units or other devices that emit noise if at all possible as measurements may be affected by these sounds.
• Operating the MASTER VOLUME knob on the main unit or the VOL +/– buttons on the remote control unit during the measurements will cancel the measurements.
• Do not change the speaker connections or subwoofer volume after “Step 1”.
a Start Menu
The settings are performed automatically.
NOTE
Do not turn the power off while the settings are being stored.
Step 2 : Measurement
After completing a measurement position, move the microphone to the next position.
Measure at least 6 positions (main listening position and at least 5 other surrounding positions). For best results it is recommend measuring 6
or more positions (with a maximum of 8 positions).
Step 3 : Calculation
When “Calculate” is selected at “Step 2”, the measurements taken are analyzed automatically to determine how the speaker system interacts with the room.
The time required for this analysis depends on the number of speakers connected. The higher the number of speakers, the longer the time required for analysis.
Step 4 : Check
Once the auto setup procedure is complete, a measuring result check screen appears. Select any item whose results you want to check to review the results.
Values that are different from the actual distance may be set for speakers with built-in filters (subwoofers, etc.). This is because filters add electrical delay to the signal that should be compensated.
Step 5 : Store
The auto setup measurement results are stored in the AVR-2808CI.
Front Speaker
The front speaker to be measured can be selected ahead of time here.
[Selectable items]
A
: Output test tone from front speakers A.
B
: Output test tone from front speakers B.
A + B
: Output test tone from front speakers A and B.
Amp Assign
Advanced setting : changes power amplifier assignment. For details, refer to “Amp Assign” (vpage 31).
If an error message appears during the measurements, check “Error Messages”, take the advised action, then start the measurements again (vpage 25).

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 28
Error Messages
If the auto setup procedure could not be completed due to speaker installation, the measuring environment, etc., an error message is displayed. If this happens, check the relevant items, be sure to take the necessary measures, then perform the auto setup procedure over again.
Error messages (examples) Cause Measures
or
Retry Cancel
Microphone:None
Speaker :None
Auto Setup
Audyssey
MultEQ XT
Caution!
• Included setup microphone is not connected.
• Not all speakers could be detected.
• Connect the included setup microphone to the SETUP MIC jack on the main unit.
• Check the speaker connections.
too high or
Retry Cancel
Ambient noise is
Level is too low.
Auto Setup
Audyssey
MultEQ XT
Caution!
• Too much noise in the room for accurate measurements to be made.
• Speaker or subwoofer sound is too low for accurate measurements to be made.
• Either turn off any device generating noise or move it away.
• Try again when the surroundings are quieter.
• Check the speaker installation and the direction in which the speakers are facing.
• Adjust the subwoofer’s volume.
Retry
R :None
Cancel
Front
Auto Setup
Caution!
Audyssey
MultEQ XT
• Displayed speaker could not be detected.
· The front L and front R speakers were not properly detected.
· Only one channel of the surround speakers was detected.
· Sound was output from the R channel when only one surround back speaker was connected.
· The surround back speaker was detected, but the surround speaker was not detected.
• Check the connections of the displayed speaker.
Retry
L :Phase
Cancel Skip
Front
Auto Setup
Caution!
Audyssey
MultEQ XT
• Displayed speaker connected with the polarities reversed.
• Check the polarities of the displayed speaker.
• For some speakers, this error message may be displayed even if the speaker is properly connected. If you are sure that the wiring is correct, select “Skip”.
NOTE
Be sure to turn the power off before checking the speaker connections.
Room EQ
Select room EQ setting method.
[Selectable items]
All
: Apply settings to all surround modes.
Assign
: Make settings for each surround mode separately.
s
Option
Select settings for room EQ, mic, etc.
Select “Retry” to make the measurements again.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Direct Mode Setup
Select room EQ use for DIRECT or PURE DIRECT mode.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Use room EQ.
OFF
: Do not use room EQ.
Mic Select
Select the microphone type if not using supplied mic. The microphone connected to V.AUX Lch is used.
[Selectable items]
Mic
: Supplied mic is being used.
V.AUX L
: Other mic connected to V.AUX is used.
d
Parameter Check
Check auto setup measurement results. This is displayed after the auto setup procedure is completed.
The auto setup results can be reset to what was originally calculated by MultEQ XT when “Restore” is selected.
Only a professionally certified installer should ever connect a professionally-calibrated microphone to the V.AUX L input on the front panel.
[Items to be checked]
Speaker Config. Check
Distance Check
Channel Level Check
Crossover Freq. Check
EQ Check
Page 29
Make detail settings for various parameters.
Speaker Setup
Use this procedure to set the speakers manually or if you wish to change the settings made with the auto setup procedure.
F Menu screen F
MENU
1.Auto Setup
2.Manual Setup
3.Input Setup
4.Parameter
5.Information
Manual Setup
a
Speaker Configuration
Select speaker configuration and size. (bass reproduction capability)
s
Subwoofer Setup
Select low range signal to be reproduced by subwoofer.
• This can be set when menu “Speaker Configuration” – “Subwoofer” is set to “Yes”.
• Play music or a movie source and select the mode offering the strongest bass.
• Select “LFE+Main” if you want the bass signals to always be produced from the subwoofer.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
• Select “Large” or “Small” not according to the physical size of the speaker but according to the low frequency reproduction capabilities based on the frequency set at “Crossover Frequency” (vpage
27).
• When “Front Speaker” is set to “Small”, “Subwoofer” is automatically set to “Yes”.
• If “Subwoofer” is set to “No”, “Front Speaker” is automatically set to “Large”.
• If “Surround Speaker” is set to “None”, “Surround Back Speaker” are automatically set to “None”.
• When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the left channel (SBL).
Large
: Select this when using large speakers with ample low
frequency reproduction capabilities.
Small
: Select this when using small speakers without ample low
frequency reproduction capabilities.
None
: Select this when no speaker is connected.
Yes
: Select this when a subwoofer is connected.
No
: Select this when no subwoofer is connected.
2spkrs 1spkr
:
Select the number of surround back speakers.
Front Speaker
Select front speaker size.
[Selectable items]
Large Small
Subwoofer
Select subwoofer use.
[Selectable items]
Yes No
Surround Speaker
Select surround speakers use and size.
[Selectable items]
Large Small None
Surround Back Speaker
Select surround back speaker use and size.
[Selectable items]
(
Large Small None
)
(
2spkrs 1spkr
)
Center Speaker
Select center speaker use and size.
[Selectable items]
Large Small None
[Selectable items]
LFE
: Play low range and LFE signal of channels set to
“Small”.
LFE+Main
: Play low range and LFE signal of all channels.
2.Manual Setup
2.HDMI Setup
1.Speaker Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
3.Audio Setup
d
Distance
Set distance from listening position to speakers. Before making the settings, measure the distance from the listening position to the different speakers.
Feet / Meters
Select unit for distance.
Step
Select step. (smallest distance)
[Selectable items]
1ft 0.1ft
: Can be selected when “Feet” is set.
0.1m 0.01m
: Can be selected when “Meters” is set.
Default
Resets the settings to the default values.
NOTE
By default, the AVR-2808CI’s “Amp Assign” setting is set to “ZONE2”. To use as the surround back speaker for the main zone, change the “Amp Assign” setting (vpage 31).
Page 30
• When the menu “Speaker Configuration” – “Surround Back Speaker” setting (vpage 26) is set to “1spkr”, the surround back speaker display is set to “Surround Back Sp.” .
• Speakers set to “None” in the “Speaker Configuration” settings are not displayed.
• When “Channel Level” is adjusted, the adjusted values are set for all the surround modes. To adjust the channel level separately for the different surround modes, use the operation see page 48.
Distance measurement
Select the speaker you want to set, then set the distance. Set the value closest to the measured distance.
[Variable range]
0.0ft ~ 60.0ft
: Display when “Feet” is set.
0.00m ~ 18.00m
: Display when “Meters” is set.
Test Tone
Select test tone playback method.
[Selectable items]
Auto
: Automatically switch speaker from which test tone is
output.
Manual
: Manually switch speaker from which test tone is output.
f
Channel Level
Adjust channel levels to obtain equal volume from all speakers.
Operating from the main remote control unit
Adjusting with the main remote control unit using the test tones is only possible in the “Auto” mode and only effective in the STANDARD mode. The adjusted levels for the different modes are automatically stored in the memory.
GAdjusting using test tonesH
q Press the TEST button. Test tones are output from the various speakers. w Use the o p button to adjust so that the volume is equal for all
speakers.
e When the adjustments are completed, press the TEST button
again.
Test Tone Start
Output test tone.
[Variable range]
–12dB
~
0dB
~
+12dB
NOTE
Set the distance between the listening position and the various speakers to no more than 20.0 ft (6.00 meters).
Default
Resets the settings to the default values.
g
Crossover Frequency
Select crossover frequency from which subwoofer handles low range signal.
[Selectable items]
40Hz 60Hz 80Hz 90Hz 100Hz 110Hz 120Hz 150Hz
200Hz 250Hz
:
Only the portion of the bass sound of the various speakers output from the subwoofer that has a frequency below the frequency set here is output. Set this according to the low frequency reproduction capabilities of the
speakers you are using.
Advanced
:
Set the crossover frequency separately for the different speakers.
• The “Crossover Frequency” can be set when there are speakers that have been set to “Small” at menu “Speaker Configuration” or when “Subwoofer” is set to “Yes” (vpage 26).
• If in the “Advanced” settings, “Subwoofer Setup” in the menu is set to “LFE”, it is possible to make this setting for speakers set to “Small“ at “Speaker Configuration”. If set to “LFE+Main”, this setting can be made regardless of the speaker size.
• For speakers set to “Small”, sound below the crossover frequency is cut from the sound output. The cut bass sound is output from the subwoofer or front speakers.
• Always set the crossover frequency to “80 Hz”. When using small speakers, however, we recommend setting the crossover frequency to a higher frequency.
HDMI Setup
Make settings for HDMI video/audio output.
F Menu screen F
2.Manual Setup
2.HDMI Setup
1.Speaker Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
3.Audio Setup
a
HDMI Audio Setup
Make settings for HDMI audio output.
2.HDMI Video Setup
1.HDMI Audio Setup
2-2.HDMI Setup
HDMI Audio Out
Select HDMI audio output device.
[Selectable items]
AMP
: Use speakers connected to receiver for audio playback.
TV
: Use speakers of monitor for audio playback.
Auto Lipsync
Automatic compensation for timing shift in audio and video output.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Use automatic compensation.
OFF
: Do not use automatic compensation.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 31
NOTE
• It is not possible to convert “1080i” signals into “720p” format.
• It is not possible to convert “720p” signals into “1080i” format.
This can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to “A to H”.
s
HDMI Video Setup
Make settings for HDMI video output.
i/p Scaler
Make settings for i/p scaler function.
[Selectable items]
A to H
: Use i/p scaler function for analog video signal.
OFF
: Do not use i/p scaler function.
Resolution
Make settings for resolution of HDMI video output signal.
[Selectable items]
Auto
: Detect monitor panel resolution and automatically set
output resolution.
480p/576p
: Output at 480p/576p resolution.
1080i
: Output at 1080i resolution.
720p
: Output at 720p resolution.
1080p
: Output at 1080p resolution.
Progressive Mode
Select optimum progressive mode for video material.
[Selectable items]
Auto
: Automatically detect video material type.
Video1
: Select mode suitable for video playback.
Video2
: Select mode suitable for video and 30-frame film material
playback.
This can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to “A to H”.
Color Space
Make settings for output color space.
[Selectable items]
YCbCr
: Output using YCbCr format.
RGB
: Output using RGB format.
When connected to a monitor with a DVI-D connector (HDCP compatible) using an HDMI/DVI converter cable, the signals are output in RGB format, regardless of this setting.
RGB Range
Make settings for RGB output range.
[Selectable items]
Normal
: Use video range from 16 (black) to 235 (white).
Enhanced
: Video range from 0 (black) to 255 (white). Use this setting
to avoid black washout.
Audio Setup
Make settings for audio playback.
F Menu screen F
2.Manual Setup
2.HDMI Setup
1.Speaker Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
3.Audio Setup
2.2ch Direct/Stereo
3.Dolby Digital Setup
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Manual EQ
1.EXT.IN SW Level
2-3.Audio Setup
a
EXT. IN Subwoofer Level
Set the subwoofer level for playback.
[Selectable items]
0dB +5dB +10dB
:
Select according to the player in use.
+15dB
:
This is the recommended level.
s
2ch Direct/Stereo
Make speaker settings for 2-channel mode playback.
Setting
To change the settings, select “Custom”.
[Selectable items]
Basic
: Use the same settings as in “Speaker Setup”.
Custom
: Make separate settings for 2-channel mode.
Aspect
This sets the aspect ratio when outputting 480i/576i or 480p/576p input signals from the HDMI output connector.
[Selectable items]
FULL
: Output at 16:9 aspect ratio.
NORMAL
: Output at 4:3 aspect ratio.
This can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to “A to H”.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 32
Subwoofer Mode
Select low range signal to be reproduced by subwoofer.
[Selectable items]
LFE LFE+Main
: Select subwoofer signal.
Crossover
Select crossover frequency from which subwoofer handles low range signal.
[Selectable items]
40Hz 60Hz 80Hz 90Hz 100Hz 110Hz 120Hz 150Hz
200Hz 250Hz
: Select crossover frequency.
Distance FL
Set distance from listening position to front left speaker.
[Variable range]
0.0ft ~ 60.0ft
Distance FR
Set distance from listening position to front right speaker.
[Variable range]
0.0ft ~ 60.0ft
d
Dolby Digital Setup
Set dynamic range for downmix playback of Dolby Digital sources.
• Set this to “ON” if the sound from the front speakers seems distorted.
• When not using the center speaker or surround speakers, the playback sound is down-mixed and output from the front speakers.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Compression is used. Select this if sound from front
speakers is distorted.
OFF
: Do not use compression. This is the recommended setting.
f
Auto Surround Mode
Make setting for memorizing surround mode setting for each input signal type.
• The auto surround mode function lets you store in the memory the surround mode last used for playing the four types of input signals listed below.
q Analog and PCM 2-channel signals w Dolby Digital and DTS 2-channel signals e Dolby Digital and DTS multi-channel signals r Multi-channel signals other than Dolby Digital and DTS (PCM,
DSD, etc.)
• When playing in the PURE DIRECT mode, the surround mode does not change even if the input signal is changed.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Memorize settings. Most recently stored surround mode is
automatically selected.
OFF
: Do not memorize settings. Surround mode does not change
according to input signal.
Front
Select front speaker size.
[Selectable items]
Large Small
: Select front speaker size.
Subwoofer
Select subwoofer use.
[Selectable items]
Yes No
: Select subwoofer use.
g
Manual EQ
Adjust tonal quality for each speaker using graphic equalizer.
Base Curve Copy
Copy the Room EQ´s “Audyssey Flat” correction curve.
[Selectable items]
Yes
No
“Base Curve Copy” is displayed after the auto setup procedure has been performed.
Adjust CH
Select speaker adjustment method.
[Selectable items]
Each CH
: Adjust tonal quality for each speaker separately.
L/R CH
: Adjust tonal quality for each L/R speaker pair.
ALL CH
: Adjust tonal quality for all speakers together.
Default
Resets the settings to the default values.
Manual EQ
Select the speaker and frequency band and adjust the level.
[Selectable items]
63Hz 125Hz 250Hz 500Hz 1kHz
2kHz 4kHz 8kHz 16kHz
[Variable range]
–20dB
~
0dB
~
+6dB

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 33
Zone Setup
Make settings for audio playback in a multi-zone system.
F Menu screen F
2.Manual Setup
2.HDMI Setup
1.Speaker Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
3.Audio Setup
a
ZONE2 Setup
Make settings for audio playback in a ZONE2 system.
s
ZONE3 Setup
Make settings for audio playback in a ZONE3 system.
Bass
Adjust low frequency range (bass).
[Variable range]
–10dB
~
0dB
~
+10dB
Treble
Adjust high frequency range (treble).
[Variable range]
–10dB
~
0dB
~
+10dB
HPF
When using speakers that cannot satisfactorily play low frequencies, distortion of the bass sound can be reduced by setting “HPF” to “ON”.
[Selectable items]
OFF
: The low range is not attenuated.
ON
: The low range is attenuated.
Lch Level
Adjust the left channel output level.
[Variable range]
–12dB
~
0dB
~
+12dB
Rch Level
Adjust the right channel output level.
[Variable range]
–12dB
~
0dB
~
+12dB
Channel
Switch between stereo and mono output.
[Selectable items]
Stereo
: Select stereo output.
Mono
: Select monaural output.
When menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Amp Assign” (vpage 31) is set to ZONE2/3-MONO”, the “Channel” setting is automatically set to “Mono”.
2.ZONE3 Setup
1.ZONE2 Setup
2-4.Zone Setup
Volume Limit
Make a setting for maximum volume.
[Selectable items]
OFF
: Do not set a maximum volume.
–20dB
: Set the maximum volume to –20 dB.
–10dB
: Set the maximum volume to –10 dB.
0dB
: Set the maximum volume to 0 dB.
Power On Level
Define the volume setting that is active when the power is turned on.
[Selectable items]
Last
: Use the memorized setting from the last session.
– – –
: Always use the muting on condition when power
is turned on.
–70dB ~ +18dB
: Set the volume level when the power is turned on
in units of 1 dB.
Mute Level
Set the amount of attenuation when muting is on.
[Selectable items]
Full
: The sound is cut off entirely.
–40dB
: The sound is attenuated by 40 dB.
–20dB
: The sound is attenuated by 20 dB.
Volume Level
Adjust the main volume level.
[Selectable items]
VAR
: Allow volume adjustment by remote control.
–40dB
: Fix the volume to –40 dB.
0dB
: Fix the volume to 0 dB.
“VAR” is displayed when a power amplifier is assigned to the ZONE2 output channel at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Amp Assign” (vpage 31).
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 34
Option Setup
Make various other settings.
F Menu screen F
2.Manual Setup
2.HDMI Setup
1.Speaker Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
3.Audio Setup
a
Amp Assign
Define how the amplifier for the surround back speaker channels is used.
The places where the surround back amplifier are used can be set freely according to the usage environment. This makes it possible to output sound to rooms other than the room (the main zone) where surround playback is performed (multi-zone playback) or play the sound with high quality using the front speakers (bi-amp connections).
[Selectable items]
7.1ch ZONE2 ZONE3 ZONE2/3-MONO FrontA Bi-Amp
FrontB Bi-Amp 2ch
For details, see “Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations” (vpage 57 ~ 59).
s
Volume Control
Set the main zone volume setting.
Volume Limit
Make a setting for maximum volume.
[Selectable items]
OFF
: Do not set a maximum volume.
–20dB
: Set the maximum volume to –20 dB.
–10dB
: Set the maximum volume to –10 dB.
0dB
: Set the maximum volume to 0 dB.
Power On Level
This sets the volume set when the main zone’s power is turned on.
[Selectable items]
Last
: Use the memorized setting from the last session.
– – –
: Always use the muting on condition when power
is turned on.
–80dB ~ +18dB
: Set the volume level when the power is turned on
in units of 1 dB.
Mute Level
This sets the amount of attenuation of the volume when the mute mode is set in the main zone.
[Selectable items]
Full
: The sound is cut off entirely.
–40dB
: The sound is attenuated by 40 dB.
–20dB
: The sound is attenuated by 20 dB.
2.Vol.Control
3.Source Delete
4.On Screen Display
5.Quick Select Name
6.Trigger Out
7.Remote ID Setup
8.2Way Remote
9.Display
10.Setup Lock
1.Amp Assign
2-5.Option Setup
d
Source Delete
Remove input sources that are not used from the display.
f
On-Screen Display
Make on-screen display related settings.
NOTE
• Input sources being used in the various zones cannot be deleted.
• Input sources set to “Delete” cannot be selected using the SOURCE SELECT knob on the main unit or SOURCE SELECT button on the remote control unit.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Use this source.
Delete
: Do not use this source.
Text
Input source and mode display.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Turn display on.
OFF
: Turn display off.
Master Volume
Master volume display during adjustment.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Turn display on.
OFF
: Turn display off.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Screensaver
Make screensaver settings. Use the screensaver to prevent burn-in on the monitor screen. When set to “ON”, the screensaver is activated if there is no activity for about 3 minutes.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Activate the screensaver if there is no activity for about 3
minutes.
OFF
: Turn the screensaver function off.
Page 35
Tuner Information
This sets the time the on-screen display is displayed when an operation is performed.
[Selectable items]
Always
: Show display continuously.
30sec
: Show display for 30 seconds after operation.
10sec
: Show display for 10 seconds after operation.
OFF
: Turn display off.
Display Mode
Select the on-screen display's display mode.
[Selectable items]
Mode1
: If there is no video signal, flickering of the on-screen display
is not prevented.
Mode2
: Prevents flickering of the on-screen display when there is
no video signal.
Use this mode if the on-screen display does not appear
in the Mode 1, as may happen according to the TV being used.
g
Quick Select Name
Change the Quick Select name. Up to 16 characters can be input.
[Input characters]
A ~ Z a ~ z 0 ~ 9 ! # % & ’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; = “ ? @ [ \ ] (space)
h
Trigger Out
Select the conditions to turn on the trigger out with respect to the zone, input source, surround mode. For details about the trigger out function, see page 19.
iPod Information
This sets the time the on-screen display is displayed when an operation is performed.
[Selectable items]
Always
: Show display continuously.
30sec
: Show display for 30 seconds after operation.
10sec
: Show display for 10 seconds after operation.
OFF
: Turn display off.
j
Remote ID Setup
Set remote control ID. Match the ID setting of the remote control unit and the receiver.
When changing the remote ID, also change the AMP, iPod and TU modes of the main remote control unit at the same time (vpage
54).
k
2Way Remote
Make setting for 2-way remote control unit.
[Selectable items]
1
2
3
4
:
Match the ID setting of the remote control and the receiver.
[Selectable items]
Used
: Use 2-way remote control.
Not Used
: Do not use 2-way remote control.
When using a 2-way remote control unit (RC-7000CI and RC-7001RCI, sold separately), set this to “Used”.
l
Display
Adjust display brightness of the receiver.
Operating from the main unit
Press the DIMMER button.
Bright Dim
DarkOFF
[Selectable items]
Bright
: Normal display brightness.
Dim
: Reduced display brightness.
Dark
: Very low display brightness.
OFF
: Display is off unless controls are operated.
Setting with Respect to the Input Source
When the input source set to on is selected, the trigger out turns on.
Setting with Respect to the Surround Mode
• When the surround mode set to on is selected, the trigger out turns on.
• Associated with respect to surround modes that are set to “ON”.
• This can be set if the “MAIN ZONE” is selected at “Selecting the Zone”.
• Associated when an input source for which “Setting with Respect to the Input Source” is set to “ON” is selected.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Select “Trigger Out 1” or “Trigger Out 2” and make the settings below respectively.
Selecting the Zone
Select the zone for which the trigger out is set.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Activate trigger on this mode.
– – –
: Do not activate trigger on this mode.
Page 36
A0
Setup Lock
Protect settings from inadvertent change.
• When “Setup Lock” is set to “ON”, the settings listed below can no longer be changed. Also, “SETUP LOCKED!” is displayed if you attempt to operate related buttons.
Menu operations RESTORER Night Mode Parameter Room EQ Channel Level Audio Delay
• To cancel the setting, press the MENU button to re-display the “Setup Lock” screen, then change the setting to “OFF”.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Turn protection on.
OFF
: Turn protection off.
Input Setup

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Use this procedure to select the input source and make the settings related to playing input sources.
n TUNER (AM/FM) This menu is for “TUNER”.
F Menu screen F
2.Preset Skip
3.Preset Name
4.Input Mode
5.Rename
6.Other
1.Auto Setup
3.Input Setup
TUNER
n XM This menu is for “XM”.
F Menu screen F
1.Preset Skip
2.Antenna Aiming
3.Input Mode
4.Rename
5.Other
3.Input Setup
XM
n PHONO This menu is for “PHONO”.
F Menu screen F
1.Input Mode
2.Rename
3.Other
3.Input Setup
PHONO
Changing the input source within Input Setup
1.Assign
2.Input Mode
3.Rename
4.Other
3.Input Setup
CD
The input source currently selected in the main zone is not changed even when the input source within Input Setup is changed.
n CD, DVD, HDP, TV/CBL, SAT, VCR, DVR, V.AUX This menu is for “CD”, “DVD”, “HDP”, “TV/CBL”, “SAT”, “VCR”, “DVR”,
“V.AUX”.
F Menu screen F
1.Assign
2.Input Mode
3.Rename
4.Other
3.Input Setup
CD
b The menu settings below can be made for these input sources
when “iPod dock” is set to “Assign”.
1.Assign
2.Input Mode
3.Rename
4.Other
5.iPod
3.Input Setup
VCR
Repeat : OFF
Shuffle : OFF
3-5.iPod
Page 37
Auto Preset
Use the auto preset function to program radio stations.
[Input source]
TUNER
[Selectable items]
Start
: Start the auto preset process.
If an FM station cannot be preset automatically, select the desired station by tuning it in manually, then preset it manually.
Preset Skip
Set the preset memories that you do not want to display when tuning.
A ~ G
Select the preset channel(s) you do not want to display.
[Input source]
TUNER XM
[Selectable items]
ON
: Display this number.
Skip
: Skip this number.
Preset Name
Assign name to a preset memory. Names containing up to 8 characters can be input.
A1 ~ G8
Select the preset memory number.
[Input source]
TUNER
[Characters that can be input]
A ~ Z a ~ z 0 ~ 9 ! # % & ’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; = “ ? @ [ \ ] (space)
Input Mode
Make input mode and decode mode settings for this source. The selectable input modes depend on the input source and “Assign” setting (vpage 35).
Input Mode
Set the input mode for this source.
[Input source]
TUNER PHONO
[Selectable items]
Analog
: Play only signals from analog input.
EXT. IN
: Play only signals from EXT. IN input.
[Input source]
XM
[Selectable items]
Auto
: Automatically detect input signal and perform playback.
EXT. IN
: Play only signals from EXT. IN input.
[Input source]
CD DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
Auto
: Automatically detect input signal and perform playback.
HDMI
: Play only signals from HDMI input. Excluding CD.
Digital
: Play only signals from digital input.
Analog
: Play only signals from analog input.
EXT. IN
: Play only signals from EXT. IN input.
• When a digital signal is properly input, the “ ” indicator lights on the display. If the “ ” indicator does not light, check the digital input connector assignment and the connections.
• The surround mode cannot be set if the input mode is set to “EXT. IN”.
Operating from the main unit or main remote control unit
Press the INPUT MODE button on the main unit or the INPUT button on the main remote control unit.
Auto HDMI Digital
AnalogEXT. IN
z1
z2
z1: This can be selected for input sources for which the menu
“Assign” setting is set to “HDMI” (vpage 35). Excluding CD.
z2: This can be selected for input sources for which the menu
“Assign” setting is set to “Digital” (vpage 35).
Rename
Change the display name for this source. Names containing up to 8 characters can be input.
[Characters that can be input]
A ~ Z a ~ z 0 ~ 9 ! # % & ’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; = “ ? @ [ \ ] (space)
Decode Mode
Set the decode mode for this source.
[Input source]
CD DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
Auto
: Detect type of digital input signal and decode and play
automatically.
PCM
: Decode and play only PCM input signals.
DTS
: Decode and play only DTS input signals.
• This can be selected for input sources for which the menu “Assign”
setting is set to “HDMI” or “Digital” (vpage 35).
• Only set “PCM” and “DTS” when playing the respective signals.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Settings Related to Playing Input Sources
Page 38
• With HDMI, the video and audio signals are transferred simultaneously. If you want to play the video signal assigned at “HDMI In” together with the audio signal assigned at “Digital In”, set “Input Mode” on the menu to “DIGITAL” (vpage 34).
• When the AVR-2808CI and monitor are connected with an HDMI cable, if the monitor is not compatible with HDMI audio signal playback, only the video signals are output to the monitor.
• The audio signals input from the analog, digital and EXT. IN connectors are not output to the monitor.
Assign
Assign input sources to input connectors.
HDMI
Select HDMI connector to assign to this source.
[Input source]
DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
1
: Assign HDMI1 input connector.
2
: Assign HDMI2 input connector.
None
: No HDMI input connector assigned.
Input source
DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR V.AUX
Default setting
HDMI1 HDMI2 None None None None None

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
iPod dock
Assign Control Dock for iPod to this source.
[Input source]
CD DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
Assign
: Assign iPod input.
None
: Do not assign iPod input.
• With the default settings, the Control Dock for iPod can be used connected to the VCR (iPod) connector.
• Even if “iPod dock” is set to “Assign”, if the AVR-2808CI is not connected to a Control Dock for iPod, the input source can be used as the normal input source.
iPod
Make settings for “iPod” playback.
Repeat
Make settings for repeat mode.
[Selectable items]
All
: Repeat all songs.
One
: Repeat the current song.
OFF
: Cancel repeat mode.
[Input source]
CD DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR
V.AUX
Digital In
Select digital input connector to assign to this source.
[Input source]
CD DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
COAX1
: Assign COAXIAL 1 input connector.
COAX2
: Assign COAXIAL 2 input connector.
COAX3
: Assign COAXIAL 3 input connector.
OPT1
: Assign OPTICAL 1 input connector.
OPT2
: Assign OPTICAL 2 input connector.
OPT3
: Assign OPTICAL 3 input connector.
OPT4
: Assign OPTICAL 4 input connector.
None
: No digital input connector assigned.
Input source
CD DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR V.AUX
Default setting
COAX 3COAX
1
None
COAX 2OPT 1OPT 3OPT 2OPT
4
Component In
Select component video input to assign to this source.
[Input source]
DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
1-RCA
: Assign component video 1 input connector.
2-RCA
: Assign component video 2 input connector.
3-RCA
: Assign component video 3 input connector.
None
: No component video input connector assigned.
Input source
DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR V.AUX
Default setting
1-RCA 2-RCA 3-RCA None None None None
Page 39
Antenna Aiming
Adjust the XM radio reception sensitivity.
Satellite
Indicate satellite signal strength.
Terrestrial
Indicate terrestrial signal strength.
[Input source]
XM
DTS NEO:6
: The signals are decoded in DTS NEO:6 for
playback.
Cinema
: This mode is suited for movie sources.
Music
: This mode is suited for music sources.
neural
: It is possible to play analog input signals and
PCM (2-channel, 48 kHz or less) in the surround mode.
This is the optimum mode for playing sources
recorded in XM HD Surround (vpage 63).
Surround Playback of 2-channel Sources
DOLBY PLgx
or DOLBY PLg
: The signals are decoded in DOLBY PLgx or
DOLBY PLg for playback.
Cinema
: This mode is suited for movie sources.
Music
: This mode is suited for music sources.
Game
: This mode is suited for games.
Pro Logic
: This is the Pro Logic playback mode. This can
be selected when playing with a DOLBY PLg decoder. When this mode is selected, “DOLBY PL” is displayed.
Standard Playback
This is the standard mode for enjoying surround sound according to the program source.
Surround Modes
To select these surround modes using the buttons on the main unit and main remote control unit, press the STANDARD button. The mode switches each time the button is pressed.
n When using a surround back speaker
[Selectable items]
DOLBY PLgx
DTS NEO:6 neural
n When not using a surround back speaker
[Selectable items]
DOLBY PLg
DTS NEO:6 neural

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Source Level
Corrects the playback level of the selected input source’s audio input.
[Variable range]
–12dB
~
0dB
~
+12dB
For input sources for which “HDMI” or “Digital” are set at the menu “Assign” setting, the analog input level and digital input level can be set separately.
Other
Make various other settings.
Video Select
Switch video input source while listening to audio signal.
[Selectable items]
DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR V.AUX
:
Select video input source to view.
Source
:
The video and audio for the same input source are played.
Operating from the main unit
Press the VIDEO SELECT button, then turn the SOURCE SELECT knob until the desired picture appears. b To cancel, press the main unit’s VIDEO SELECT button, then turn the
main unit’s SOURCE SELECT knob and select “Source”.
NOTE
• It is not possible to select HDMI input signals.
• When playing HDMI video input signals, the analog video signal of another input source cannot be selected for the HDMI video output.
• Input sources for which “Delete” is selected at “Source Delete” cannot be selected.
Video Convert
Automatically convert video input signal to monitor output format.
[Input source]
DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
ON
: Enable conversion.
OFF
: Disable conversion.
Shuffle
Make settings for shuffle mode.
[Selectable items]
Songs
: Shuffle all songs.
Albums
: Shuffle songs from current album only.
OFF
: Cancel shuffle mode.
This can be selected for input sources for which “Assign” is assigned at the “iPod dock” setting.
Display Condition
Signal strength is strong Signal strength is good Signal strength is marginal Signal strength is weak No signal
NOTE
When a non-standard video signal from a game machine or some other source is input, the video conversion function might not operate. If this happens, please set the conversion mode to “OFF”.
Page 40
Select the “Cinema”, “Music”, “Game” and “Pro Logic” modes at menu “Parameter” – “Surround Parameter” – “MODE” (vpage 38).
Input signal Display
Dolby
Digital
Source
DOLBY DIGITAL
(other than 2ch) /
DOLBY DIGITAL
EX
DOLBY DIGITAL DOLBY DIGITAL EX DOLBY DIGITAL+PLgx CINEMA DOLBY DIGITAL+PLgx MUSIC
DOLBY DIGITAL
Plus
DOLBY DIGITAL +
DOLBY TrueHD DOLBY TrueHD
DTS
Surround
Source
DTS (5.1ch) /
DTS-ES Discrete
6.1 /
DTS-ES Matrix
6.1 /
DTS 96/24
DTS SURROUND DTS+PLgx CINEMA DTS+PLgx MUSIC DTS+NEO:6 DTS ES MTRX6.1 (z1) DTS ES DSCRT6.1 (z2) DTS 96/24 (z3)
DTS-HD High
Resolution Audio
DTS-HD HI RES
DTS-HD Master
Audio
DTS-HD MSTR
DVD-
Audio,
SACD
PCM (multi ch) /
DSD (multi ch)
MULTI CH IN MULTI IN+PLgx CINEMA MULTI IN+PLgx MUSIC MULTI CH IN 7.1
z1 : This is displayed when the input signal is “DTS-ES Matrix 6.1”
and the AVR-2808CI’s “AFDM” setting is set to “ON”.
z2 : This is displayed when the input signal is “DTS-ES Discrete
6.1”.
z3 : This is displayed when the input signal is “DTS 96/24”.
For details, see page 66.
Playing Multi-channel Sources (Dolby Digital, DTS, etc.)
[Selectable items]
STANDARD
:
This mode is for decoding the input signals according to their format and playing surround sound. The display when the STANDARD mode is selected depends on the input signal and surround back output playback mode.
• To select these surround modes using the buttons on the main
remote control unit, press the SIMU button. The mode switches each time the button is pressed.
• Depending on the program source being played, it may not be possible to achieve a satisfactory surround effect. In this case, try other modes to achieve a sound field suited to your tastes.
DSP Simulation Playback
The desired mode according to the program source and viewing situation can be selected from among 10 DENON original surround modes. The surround parameters can be adjusted (vpage 64, 65) to achieve an even more realistic, powerful sound field.
[Selectable items]
7CH STEREO
: This mode is for enjoying stereo sound from
all speakers.
WIDE SCREEN
: This mode is for enjoying the atmosphere of
viewing a movie on a large screen.
SUPER STADIUM
: This mode is suited for viewing sports
programs.
ROCK ARENA
: This mode is for enjoying the atmosphere of a
live concert in an arena.
JAZZ CLUB
:
This mode is for enjoying the atmosphere of a
live concert in a jazz club.
CLASSIC CONCERT
: This mode is for appreciating classical concert
programs
.
MONO MOVIE
z
: This mode is for playing monaural movie
sources with surround sound.
VIDEO GAME
: This mode is suited for achieving surround
sound with video games.
MATRIX
: This mode lets you add a sense of expansion
to stereo music sources.
VIRTUAL
: This mode is for enjoying surround effects
using only the front speakers or headphones.
z: When playing sources recorded in monaural in the MONO MOVIE
mode, the sound will be off balance with a single channel (left or right), so input to both channels.
Input signal
Display
Analog signal /
PCM (2ch) /
Dolby Digital source /
DTS source /
Other 2-channel digital signals
DIRECT
DSD (2ch) DSD DIRECT (z)
PCM (multi ch)
MULTI CH DIRECT M DIRECT + PLgx CINEMA M DIRECT + PLgx MUSIC M DIRECT 7.1
DSD (multi ch) DSD MULTI DIRECT (z)
z : When DSD signals are converted to PCM signals as set by the
audio parameters and speaker settings, “DIRECT” or “MULTI CH DIRECT” is displayed.
For details, see page 67.
Direct Playback
[Selectable items]
DIRECT
:
In this mode the signals bypass the tone adjustment circuitry for high quality sound. The sound is output to the same channels as the input signal. The display when the DIRECT mode is selected depends on the input signal. For multi-channel sources, the display depends on the surround back output’s play mode.
Stereo Playback
[Selectable items]
STEREO
:
This is the mode for playing in stereo. The tone can be adjusted. Sound is output from the front left and right speakers and subwoofer.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 41
Playback in the PURE DIRECT Mode
This is the mode that recreates the original sound most faithfully, providing extremely high quality sound.
• When in the PURE DIRECT mode, the menu screen is not displayed and the display on the main unit is turned off.
• If the HDMI input connector is selected, video outputs are output in the PURE DIRECT mode.
• The channel level and surround parameters in the PURE DIRECT mode are the same as in the DIRECT mode.
Press the PURE DIRECT button.
F Menu screen F
2.Tone Control
3.Room EQ
4.RESTORER
5.Night Mode
6.Audio Delay
1.Surround Parameter
4.Parameter
Parameter
Parameters can be called out directly by pressing the PARA button on the main remote control unit.
a
Surround Parameter
Adjust surround sound parameters. The adjustable parameters differ for the different surround modes (vpage 64, 65).
MODE
Select the mode according to the playback source.
n In the DOLBY PLgx mode
[Selectable items]
PLgx CINEMA PLgx MUSIC
PLgx GAME
n In the DOLBY PLg mode
[Selectable items]
PLg CINEMA
PLg MUSIC
PLg GAME
DOLBY PL
n In the DTS NEO:6 mode
[Selectable items]
CINEMA MUSIC
CINEMA
: Surround sound mode optimized for movie sources.
MUSIC
: Surround sound mode optimized for music sources.
GAME
: Surround sound mode optimized for games.
PL
: Dolby Pro Logic playback mode.
The MUSIC mode is also effective for movie sources including a lot of stereo music.
CINEMA EQ
Soften the treble range of movie soundtracks for better understanding.
[Selectable items]
ON
: CINEMA EQ is used.
OFF
: CINEMA EQ is not used.
D.COMP
Compress dynamic range (difference between loud and soft sounds).
[Selectable items]
OFF
: Turn dynamic range compression off.
LOW
: Low setting.
MID
: Middle setting.
HIGH
: High setting.
When playing DTS sources, this is only displayed for compatible software.
DRC
Compress dynamic range (difference between loud and soft sounds).
[Selectable items]
AUTO
: Automatic dynamic range compression on/off control
according to source.
LOW
: Low setting.
MID
: Middle setting.
HIGH
: High setting.
OFF
: Dynamic range compression always off.
This can be set in the Dolby TrueHD mode.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 42
LFE
Adjust the low-frequency effects level (LFE).
[Variable range]
–10dB
~
0dB
CENTER IMAGE
Assign center channel signal to front left and right channels for wider sound.
[Variable range]
0.0
~
0.3
~
1.0
PANORAMA
Assign front L/R signal also to surround channels, for wider sound. If the surround effect seems weak, set “PANORAMA” to “ON”.
[Selectable items]
ON
OFF
For proper playback of the different program sources, we recommend setting to the values below.
• Dolby Digital sources: “0 dB”
• DTS movie sources: “0 dB”
• DTS music sources: “–10 dB”
EFFECT
Switch effect signal for multi-surround speakers on and off. When “EFFECT” is set to “ON”, a surround effect with a strong sense of expansion is achieved.
[Selectable items]
ON OFF
DIMENSION
Shift sound image center to front or rear, to adjust playback balance.
[Variable range]
0
~ 3 ~
6
DELAY TIME
Adjust delay time to control sound stage size.
[Variable range]
0 ms
~
30 ms
~
300 ms
CENTER WIDTH
Assign center channel signal to front left and right channels for wider sound.
[Variable range]
0
~ 3 ~
7
LEVEL
Adjust effect signal level.
[Variable range]
1
~ 10 ~
15
Set to a lower level if the positioning and sense of phase of the surround signals seems unnatural.
ROOM SIZE
Determine size of acoustic environment.
[Selectable items]
small
: Simulate acoustics of a small room.
med. s
medium
med. l
large
: Simulate acoustics of a large room.
NOTE
“ROOM SIZE” does not indicate the size of the room in which sources are played.
Some Dolby Digital EX sources do not include EX flags. If the playback mode does not switch automatically even when “AFDM” is set to “ON”, set “SB CH OUT” to “MTRX ON” or “PLIIx CINEMA”.
AFDM (Auto Flag Detect Mode)
Auto-select surround mode by source. This function only works for software containing a special identification signal. If the software being played is recorded in Dolby Digital EX or DTS-ES, it is played in 6.1-channels. If not, it is played in 5.1-channels.
[Selectable items]
ON OFF
Example : Playing Dolby Digital software (with EX flag)
• When “AFDM” is set to “ON”, the surround mode is automatically
set to the DOLBY D + PLgx C mode.
• To play in the DOLBY DIGITAL EX mode, set “AFDM” to “OFF” and “SB CH OUT” to “MTRX ON”.
SB CH OUT (for Multi-channel sources)
Select playback mode for surround back channels.
[Selectable items]
OFF
: No signal is played from the surround back
channels.
NON MTRX
: The same signals as those of the surround
channels are output from the surround back channels.
MTRX ON
: The surround channel signals undergo digital
matrix processing and are output from the surround back channels.
PLIIx CINEMA
z1
: Decoded in Dolby Pro Logic IIx Cinema mode,
surround back signal played.
PLIIx MUSIC
z2
: Decoded in Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music mode,
surround back signal played.
ES MTRX
z3
: DTS signal played with digital matrix processing.
ES DSCRT
z4
: Signal included in DTS-ES Discrete 6.1-channel
sources played.
DSCRT ON
:
Mode for discrete playback of surround back signals included in 7.1-channel digital discrete audio signals (DVD, etc.).
z
1: This can be selected when “ Surround Back” is set to “ 2spkrs”
at the menu “ Manual Setup” – “ Speaker Setup” – “ Speaker Configuration” setting (vpage 26).
z2: This can be selected when “Surround Back” is set to “2spkrs”
or “1spkr” at the menu “Manual Setup” – “Speaker Setup” – “Speaker Configuration” setting.
z3: This can be selected when playing DTS sources. z4: This can be selected when playing DTS sources including a
discrete 6.1-channel signal identification signal.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 43
SB CH OUT (for 2-channel sources)
Determine whether to use surround back speakers.
[Selectable items]
ON
: The surround back channel signal is played.
OFF
: The surround back channel signal is not played.
SW ATT (Subwoofer Attenuate)
Attenuate subwoofer level when using EXT. IN mode.
[Selectable items]
ON
: The input from the subwoofer channel is attenuated.
OFF
: The input from the subwoofer channel is not attenuated.
Usually use in this mode.
Set this to “ON” if the subwoofer channel level seems too high when playing Super Audio CD.
Subwoofer
Turn subwoofer output on and off.
[Selectable items]
ON
: The subwoofer is used.
OFF
: The subwoofer is not used.
Default
Resets the settings to the default values.
s
Tone Control
Adjust the tonal quality of the sound.
Tone Defeat
Turn tone adjustments off.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Playback without tone adjustment.
OFF
: Allow tone adjustment (treble, bass).
The tone cannot be adjusted when in the DIRECT mode.
Bass
Adjust low frequency range (bass).
[Variable range]
–6dB ~ +6dB
Treble
Adjust high frequency range (treble).
[Variable range]
–6dB ~ +6dB
“Bass” and “Treble” can be set when “Tone Defeat” is set to “OFF”.
d
Room EQ
Select room equalizer for current environment.
Operating from the main unit or main remote control unit
Press the ROOM EQ button on the main unit or the EQ button on the main remote control.
Audyssey
Audyssey Byp. L/R
Audyssey Flat
Manual
OFF
When “Audyssey” is selected, “ ” lights.
When “Audyssey Byp. L/R” or “Audyssey Flat” is selected, or when the auto setup measuring results have changed, “ ” lights.
• “Audyssey”, “Audyssey Byp. L/R” and “Audyssey Flat” can be selected after the auto setup procedure has been performed.
• If the settings of the speakers for which “None” has been determined at “Auto Setup” are changed, “Audyssey”, “Audyssey Byp. L/R” and “Audyssey Flat” cannot be selected and measurements have to be taken again to include the newly-added speakers.
• When using headphones, “Room EQ” is always set to “OFF”.
[Selectable items]
Audyssey
: Optimize frequency response of all speakers.
Audyssey Byp. L/R
: Optimize frequency response of speakers
except front L and R speakers.
Audyssey Flat
: Optimize frequency response of all speakers to
flat response.
Manual
: Apply frequency response set with “Manual
EQ” (vpage 29).
OFF
: Turn equalizer off.
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
This operation can be performed directly pressing the SURROUND BACK button on the main unit.
Page 44
f
RESTORER
This function restores compressed audio signals to how they were before compression and corrects the sense of volume of the bass to obtain richer playback sound.
[Selectable items]
OFF
:
Do not use RESTORER.
Mode1
(RESTORER 64):
Optimized mode for compressed sources with very weak highs.
Mode2
(RESTORER 96):
Apply suitable bass and treble boost for all compressed sources.
Mode3
(RESTORER HQ):
Optimized mode for compressed sources with normal highs.
g
Night Mode
Optimized setting for late-night listening.
Operating from the main remote control unit
Press the NGT button. The “ ” indicator lights when “LOW”, “MID” or “HIGH” is
selected.
OFF LOW MID
HIGH
[Selectable items]
OFF
: Turn night mode off.
LOW
: Low setting.
MID
: Middle setting.
HIGH
: High setting.
h
Audio Delay
Compensate for mismatched timing between video and audio.
• This cannot be adjusted when playing in the EXT. IN, DIRECT or STEREO mode (with “Front Speaker” set to “Large”, “Tone Defeat” to “ON” and “Room EQ” to “OFF”.)
• The adjustment range is 0 to 100 ms when the Auto Lipsync Correction function is activated.
Operating from the main unit or main remote control unit
b When set using the procedure below, the on-screen display is not
displayed. Adjust while watching the display.
q Press the AUDIO DELAY button on the main unit or the A. DL button
on the main remote control unit.
w Use the o p button to set.
Delay audio. This sets the delay time for audio signals.
[Variable range]
0 ms
~
200 ms
If you wish to adjust the “Audio Delay” while playing HDMI or component video signals, press u to set “OSD” to “OFF”. This way the audio delay can be adjusted while watching the picture. (Press u again to switch to the on-screen display.)
Information
Status
Shows information about current settings.
F Menu screen F
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
1.Status
5.Information
a
Main zone
Shows information about settings for main zone. The items displayed differ according to the input source.
[Items to be checked]
Select Source Name Surround Mode Input Mode
Rec Select Video Select Source Level Room EQ
Night Mode RESTORER
etc.
s
ZONE2 / ZONE3
Shows information about settings for multi-zone.
[Items to be checked]
Power Select Source Volume Level
Name :Record
Surround Mode: STEREO
Select Source:
5-1.Status
PHONO
Input Mode :ANALOG
1/4

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
About the RESTORER function
• Such compressed audio formats as MP3, WMA (Windows Media Audio) and MPEG-4 AAC reduce the amount of data by eliminating signal components that are hard for the human ear to hear. The RESTORER function generates the signals eliminated upon compression, restoring the sound to conditions near those of the original sound before compression. It also corrects the sense of volume of the bass to obtain richer sound with compressed audio
signals.
• This is displayed on the menu and can be set when the input source is selected to “XM”, or analog signals (including AM/FM signals) or PCM signals (fs = 44.1/48 kHz) are input.
Operating from the main unit or main remote control unit
During playback, press the RESTORER button on the main unit or the RSTR button on the main remote control unit.
When set to something other than “OFF”, “ ” is displayed.
OFF Mode 1 Mode 2
Mode 3
The default setting for “iPod” is “Mode3”. All others are set to “OFF”.
(RESTORER 64)
(RESTORER 96)
(RESTORER HQ)
Page 45
Audio Input Signal
Shows information about audio input signals.
F Menu screen F
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
1.Status
5.Information
Dialogue normalization function
This is automatically activated when playing Dolby Digital sources. This function automatically corrects the standard signal level for individual program sources. The correction value can be checked using the STATUS button on the main unit.
The figure is the correction value when the standard level is corrected.
[Items to be checked]
Surround Mode
: The currently set surround mode is displayed.
SIGNAL
: The input signal type is displayed.
fs
: The input signal’s sampling frequency is
displayed.
Format
: The number of channels in the input signal (front,
surround, LFE) is displayed.
Offset
: The dialogue normalization correction value is
displayed.
Flag
: “MATRIX” is displayed if the input signal has
undergone matrix processing, “DISCRETE” if the input signal has undergone discrete processing.
HDMI Information
Shows information about HDMI input signal and monitor.
F Menu screen F
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
1.Status
5.Information
a
HDMI Signal Information
The HDMI input signal information is displayed.
[Items to be checked]
Resolution Color Space Pixel Depth
s
HDMI Monitor Information
The HDMI monitor information is displayed.
[Items to be checked]
Interface Support Resolution
Auto Surround Mode
Shows information about auto surround mode settings. The surround mode for which the last memory function was used for the different input signal types is displayed.
F Menu screen F
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
1.Status
5.Information
[Items to be checked]
Analog/PCM 2CH Multi ch Digital 2CH Digital 5.1CH
Quick Select
Shows information about quick select settings.
F Menu screen F
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
1.Status
5.Information
For instructions on storing settings at Quick Select 1 to 3, see page
50.
[Items to be checked]
Name Input Source Input Mode Volume Level
Analog/PCM 2CH Multi ch Digital 2CH Digital 5.1CH
Preset Station
Shows information about preset stations.
F Menu screen F
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
1.Status
5.Information
[Input source]
TUNER XM
[Items to be checked]
A1 ~ G8
When the STATUS button on the main unit is pressed, the set’s status can be checked on the display.
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
SIGNAL:Dolby Digital
fs :48kHz Format:3/2/.1 Offset:-4dB
Surround Mode:
5-2.Audio Input Signal
480p
Color Space
RGB 4:4:4
Pixel Depth 8bits
Resolution
5-3.HDMI Signal Info.
5-4.Auto Surround Mode
[Analog][PCM] 2CH:STEREO
[Multi ch] :MULTI CH IN
[Digital] 2CH:DOLBY PLIIx Cinema
5.1CH:DOLBY/DTS SURROUND
5-6.Preset Station
A1FM 87.50M
Hz
A2FM 89.10M
Hz
A3FM 98.10M
Hz
A4FM107.90M
Hz
A5FM 90.10M
Hz
A6FM 90.10M
Hz
A7FM 90.10M
Hz
A8FM 90.10M
Hz
5-5.Quick Select
1/2
1.Quick Select 1
2.Quick Select 2
3.Quick Select 3

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 46
<POWER>
<PHONES>
<ON/STANDBY>
<SOURCE> <TUNING PRESET> MASTER VOLUME
SOURCE SELECT
SPEAKER
Playback
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit [ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
Preparations
1
Press <POWER>.
The power indicator lights red and the power is set to the standby mode.
2
Press <ON/STANDBY> or [POWER ON].
The power indicator flashes green and the power turns on.
To operate the AVR-2808CI using the main remote control unit, set the remote control unit to the AMP mode (vpage 51 “Remote Control
Unit Operations”).
Turning the Power Off
q Press <ON/STANDBY> or [POWER OFF].
The power is set to the standby mode.
w Press <POWER>.
The power indicator turns off, and so does the power.
NOTE
Power continues to be supplied to some of the circuitry even when the power is in the standby mode. When leaving home for long periods of time or when traveling, either press <POWER> to turn off the power, or unplug the power cord from the power outlet.
Turning the Power On
Either turn <MASTER VOLUME> or press [MASTER
VOLUME].
Operations During Playback
Adjusting the Master Volume
Press [MUTE].
To cancel, press [MUTE] again. Muting can also be canceled by adjusting the master volume.
Plug the headphones into <PHONES>.
The sound from the speakers and pre-out connectors is automatically cut.
NOTE
Be careful not to set the volume too high when using headphones.
Turning Off the Sound Temporarily (Muting)
Listening with Headphones
To operate the AVR-2808CI using the main remote control unit, set the remote control unit to the AMP mode (vpage 51 “Remote Control
Unit Operations”).
Selecting the input source
Operation on the main unit
Turn <SOURCE SELECT>.
If “Rec Select” or “Video Select” is selected for the input source, press <SOURCE> before turning <SOURCE SELECT>.
Operation on the main remote control unit
Press [SOURCE SELECT].
The desired input source can be selected directly.
[TUNER]
SOURCE SELECT
[POWER ON]
[MUTE]
[POWER OFF]
MASTER
VOLUME
SPEAKER
[ AMP]
[ TU]
[BAND]
[A ~ G]
[MODE]
[MEMO]
[d f]
[1 ~ 8]
[SHIFT]
[CHANNEL]

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Press SPEAKER.
Front A Front B
Front A+B
Switching the front speakers
( mode)
Page 47
Presetting Radio Stations (Preset Memory)
Your favorite broadcast stations can be preset so that you can tune them in easily. Up to 56 stations can be preset.
1
Tune in the broadcast station you want to preset.
2
Press [MEMO].
3
Press [A ~ G] to select the block in which the station is
to be preset, then press [CHANNEL] or [1 ~ 8] to select the preset number.
b The memory block can also be selected by pressing [SHIFT].
4
Press [MEMO] again to complete the setting.
• To preset other stations, repeat steps 1 to 4.
• Stations can be preset automatically at menu “Input Setup” – “Auto
Preset” (vpage 34).
NOTE
Preset stations are erased by overwriting them.
1
Either turn <SOURCE SELECT> or press [TUNER]
(AMP mode) to select “TUNER”.
2
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the TUNER ( ) mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
3
Press [BAND] to select “FM” or “AM”.
4
Tune in the desired broadcast station.
q To tune in automatically (Auto Tuning)
Press [MODE] to light the “AUTO” indicator on the display, then use [df] to select the station you want to hear.
w To tune in manually (Manual Tuning)
Press [MODE] to turn off the display’s “AUTO” indicator, then use [df] to select the station you want to hear.
Listening to FM/AM Broadcasts
It is also possible to switch to “FM” or “AM” in step 1 by pressing
[TUNER].
• If the desired station cannot be tuned in with auto tuning, tune it in manually.
• When tuning in stations manually, press and hold [df] to change frequencies continuously.
• The time for which the menus are displayed can be set at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “On-Screen Display” (vpage 31, 32).
Basic Operation
Press <TUNING PRESET>, then turn <SOURCE SELECT> to select the preset radio station.
Listening to Preset Stations
Operation on the Main Unit
Operation on the Main Remote Control Unit
1
Press [A ~ G] to select the memory block.
2
Press [CHANNEL] or [1 ~ 8] to select the desired preset
channel.
n Default settings
Auto tuner presets
A1 ~ A8
87.5 / 89.1 / 98.1 / 107.9 / 90.1 / 90.1 / 90.1 /
90.1 MHz
B1 ~ B8
520 / 600 / 1000 / 1400 / 1500 / 1710 kHz,
90.1 / 90.1 MHz
C1 ~ C8
90.1 MHz
D1 ~ D8
90.1 MHz
E1 ~ E8
90.1 MHz
F1 ~ F8
90.1 MHz
G1 ~ G8
90.1 MHz
Playing Video and Audio Equipment
1
Prepare the equipment.
q Load the DVD, CD or other software in the player. (vSee the operating instructions of the respective devices.) w To play a video device, switch the monitor input. (vSee the monitor’s operating instructions.)
2
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the AMP mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
3
Use SOURCE SELECT to select the input source.
4
Start playback.
(vSee the operating instructions of the respective devices.)
Basic Operation

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 48
Note: The XM Radio ID does not use the letters “I”, “O”, “S” or “F”.
Activate your XM Satellite Radio ser vice in the U.S. online at http:// activate.xmradio.com or call 1-800-XM-RADIO (1-800-967-2346). Activate your XM Satellite Radio service in Canada online at https:// activate.xmradio.ca or call 1-877-GET-XMSR (1-877-438-9677). You will need a major credit card. XM will send a signal from the satellites to activate the full channel lineup. Activation normally takes 10 to 15 minutes, but during peak busy periods you may need to keep your XM Ready home audio system on for up to an hour. When you can access the full lineup on your XM Ready home audio system you are done.
1
Either turn <SOURCE SELECT> or press [SAT TU]
(AMP mode) to select “XM”.
2
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the TUNER ( ) mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
3
Use [df] to select the station.
When the station is tuned in, the name of the track and artist are displayed.
• The channel switches continuously when [df] is pressed and held.
• XM Radio stations can be preset using the same procedure as for
FM/AM stations (vpage 44 “Presetting Radio Stations (Preset Memory)” and “Listening to Preset Stations”).
• The artist name, track name, category and reception level can be
checked by pressing <STATUS>.
• The time for which the menus are displayed can be set at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “On-Screen Display” – “TUNER Information” (vpage 31, 32).
ABOUT XM RADIO
XM Radio offers an extraordinary variety of commercial-free music, plus the best in premier sports, news, talk radio, stand-up comedy, children’s and entertainment programming. XM is broadcast in superior digital audio from coast to coast. From rock to reggae, from classical to hip hop, XM has something for every music fan. For U.S. customers, information about XM Radio is available online at www.xmradio.com. For Canadian customers, information about XM Canada is online at www.xmradio.ca.
XM READY® LEGAL
XM monthly service subscription sold separately. XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock required (each sold separately) to receive XM service. Installation costs and other fees and taxes, including a one-time activation fee may apply. All fees and programming subject to change. Channels with frequent explicit language are indicated with an XL. Channel blocking is available for XM radio receivers by calling 1-800­XMRADIO (US residents) and 1-877-GETXMSR (Canadian residents). For a full listing of the XM commercial- free channels and advertising­supported channels, visit lineup.xmradio.com (US residents) or xmradio.ca (Canadian residents). Subscriptions subject to Customer Agreement available at xmradio.com (US residents) and xmradio.ca (Canadian residents). Only available in the 48 contiguous United States and Canada. ©2007 XM Satellite Radio Inc. All rights reserved. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
XM READY® SUBSCRIPTIONS
Once you have installed the XM Mini-Tuner Dock, inserted the XM Mini-Tuner, connected the XM Dock to your XM Ready® home audio system, and installed the antenna, you are ready to subscribe and begin receiving XM programming. There are three places to find your eight character XM Radio ID: On the XM Mini-Tuner, on the XM Mini-Tuner package, and on XM Channel 0. Record the Radio ID in the following eight squares for reference.
Listening to XM Satellite Radio Programs
Basic Operation
<SOURCE SELECT> <STATUS>
ENTER uiop
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit [ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
[SEARCH]
[BAND]
[NUMBER]
[d f]
uiop
ENTER
[SAT TU]
[ TU]

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
( mode)
(AMP mode)
Page 49
Searching Categories
1
Press o p.
2
Use o p to select the category, then use ui to select
the desired station.
Accessing XM Radio Stations Directly
1
Press [SEARCH].
2
Press [NUMBER] then input the station’s channel.
Example: Accessing station “XM123”: [1] [2] [3]
b If no button is pressed within several seconds, the station
automatically switches to the one whose number has been input.
3
Press ENTER to set that station.
Reception switches to the selected station.
• “LOADING” is displayed while stations or data are being received.
• “UPDATING” is displayed while the encoding code is being updated.
• “XM - - -” is displayed if the selected channel cannot be used.
Channel category
Checking the XM Signal Strength and Radio ID
1
Either turn <SOURCE SELECT> or press [SAT TU]
(AMP mode) to select “XM”.
2
Press <STATUS> until “SIGNAL” appears on the
display.
The display will switch as shown below, depending on the reception conditions.
Display Status GOOD Signal strength is good MARGINAL Signal strength is marginal WEAK Signal strength is weak NO No signal
3
Adjust the position of the antenna until “SIGNAL:
GOOD” is shown on the display.
4
Press <STATUS> until the station you want to check
(example: “XM001”) is displayed.
5
Press [df] and select channel 0 (XM000).
The radio ID is shown on the display.
The strength of both the XM satellite and terrestrial signals can be checked at menu “Input Setup” – “Antenna Aiming” (vpage 36).
Radio ID

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 50
uiop
[SEARCH]
[ iPod]
[CHANNEL
+ –
]
ENTER
[8],[9], [6],[7], [1],[2]
NOTE
• Depending on the type of iPod and the software version, some functions may not operate.
• DENON will accept no responsibility whatsoever for any loss of iPod data.
Listening to Music
1
Use ui to select the menu, then press ENTER or p
to select the music le to be played.
2
Press ENTER or p.
Playback starts.
Stopping playback temporarily
During playback, press ENTER or [1]. Press again to resume playback.
Fast-forwarding or fast-reversing
During playback, either press and hold u (to fast-reverse) or i (to fast-forward), or press [6] or [7].
To cue to the beginning of a track
During playback, either press u (to cue to the previous track) or i (to cue to the next track), or press [8] or [9].
To stop
During playback, either press and hold ENTER or press [2].
Playing repeatedly
Press [CHANNEL –].
[Selectable items]
All One Off
MENU : ”Input Setup” – ”iPod” – “Repeat” (vpage 35)
• With the default settings, the iPod can be used connected to the VCR (iPod) connector.
• Use the RESTORER mode to expand the low and high frequency components of compressed audio files and achieve a richer sound. The default setting is “Mode3”.
• Press <ON/STANDBY> or [POWER OFF] and set the AVR-2808CI’s power to the standby mode before disconnecting the iPod. Also switch the input source to one to which the menu “iPod dock” is not assigned before disconnecting the iPod.
iPod® Playback
The music on an iPod can be played by using the Control Dock for iPod (ASD-1R, sold separately). The operation can also be performed using the buttons on the main unit or remote control unit while watching the menus.
iPod is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
b The iPod may only be used to copy or play contents that are not
copyrighted or contents for which copying or playback is legally permitted for your private use as an individual. Be sure to comply with applicable copyright legislation.
1
Make the necessary preparations.
q Set the iPod in the DENON Control Dock for iPod. (vSee the Control Dock for iPod’s operating instructions.) w Assign the Control Dock for iPod’s input.
MENU : ”Input Setup”“Assign””iPod dock”
(vpage 36)
2
Either turn <SOURCE SELECT> or press [iPod] (AMP
mode) to select the input source assigned in step 1-w above.
(iPod screen)
b If the screens above are not displayed, the iPod may not be
properly connected. Try connecting again.
3
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the iPod mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
OK to disconnect
Basic Operation
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit [ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
<ON/STANDBY> <STATUS>
ENTERINPUT MODE uiop

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
SOURCE
SELECT
[POWER OFF]
[iPod]
INPUT MODE
Surround
Mode
[ AMP]
Page 51
Other Operations and Functions
Other Operations
Playing Super Audio CD
1
Assign the HDMI input connector at the "HDMI In"
setting (vpage 35).
2
Either turn <SOURCE SELECT> or press [SOURCE
SELECT] to select the input source assigned in step 1.
The “ ” indicator lights on the display.
3
Use INPUT MODE to select “Auto” (vpage 34).
Select the input mode according to the program source to be played.
4
Select the surround mode (vpage 36 ~ 38).
We recommend playing in the DIRECT mode.
5
Start playing the Super Audio CD.
The “ ” indicator lights on the display. For operating instructions, refer to the respective equipment’s operating instructions.
• When playing DSD signals in the DIRECT or PURE DIRECT mode, the DSD signals are converted as such into analog signals. When playing in other surround modes, the DSD signals are first converted into PCM format, then into analog signals.
• “DSD DIRECT” is shown on the display when playing DSD 2-channel signals in the DIRECT mode. “DSD MULTI DIRECT” is shown on the display when playing DSD multi--channel signals in the DIRECT mode.
Shuffling playback
Press [CHANNEL +].
[Selectable items]
Albums
Songs OFF
MENU : ”Input Setup” – ”iPod” – “Shuffle” (vpage 36)
Searching up or down pages
Press [SEARCH], then press o (down) or p (up). To cancel, press ui or [SEARCH].
To switch between the Browse and Remote modes
Either press and hold [SEARCH].
• The title name, artist name and album name can be checked by
pressing <STATUS> during playback.
• On the AVR-2808CI, folder and file names can be displayed as titles. Any characters that cannot be displayed are replaced with “ . (period)”.
• The time for which the menus are displayed can be set at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “On-Screen Display” – “iPod Information” (vpage 32).
Viewing Still Pictures or Videos on the iPod
Photo and video data on the iPod can be viewed on the monitor. Only for iPod equipped with slideshow or video functions. (When using an ASD-1R)
1
Press and hold [SEARCH] to set the Remote mode.
“Remote iPod” is displayed on the AVR-2808CI’s display.
2
Watching the iPod’s screen, use ui to select
“Photos” or “Video”.
3
Press ENTER until the image you want to view is
displayed.
“TV Out” at the iPod’s “Slideshow Settings” or “Video Settings” must be set to “On” in order to display the iPod’s photo data or videos on the monitor. For details, see the iPod’s operating instructions.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 52
• To cancel, press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT>, then turn <SOURCE SELECT>
until “ZONE2 SOURCE” is displayed.
• Make a test recording before starting the actual recording.
• Signals are only output to the analog REC OUT connectors when the digital signals input to the digital input connectors (OPTICAL/ COAXIAL) are PCM (2-channel) signals.
• Digital audio signals input to the HDMI connectors are not output to the REC OUT connectors, so connect using the OPTICAL or COAXIAL connectors.
• Sources selected with the REC OUT mode are output from ZONE2 as well.
• In the REC OUT mode, the remote control unit’s ZONE2 mode buttons cannot be operated.
• The “XM” digital audio output signals are not output from the OPTICAL2 or OPTICAL3 output connectors.
NOTE
• Recordings you make are for your personal enjoyment and should not be used for other purposes without permission of the copyright holder.
• Input sources for which “Delete” is selected at “Source Delete”cannot be selected.
Recording on an External Device (REC OUT mode)
You can listen to one program source while recording a different program source.
1
Press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT>.
“ZONE2 SOURCE” is shown on the display.
ZONE2 SOURCE ZONE2 TUNER ZONE2 XM····
RECOUT XM RECOUT TUNER RECOUT SOURCE······
2
Turn <SOURCE SELECT> until “RECOUT SOURCE”
is displayed.
The “ ” indicator lights.
3
Turn <SOURCE SELECT> to choose the input source
to be recorded.
4
Play the program source.
For operating instructions, refer to the respective equipment’s operating instructions. To record FM or AM broadcasts, select the broadcast (vpage
44).
5
Start recording.
For operating instructions, refer to the respective equipment’s operating instructions.
CH SELECT
<POWER>
<ZONE2/3 / RECSELECT>
<STANDARD> <DSP SIMULATION>
QUICK SELECT
uiop
QUICK SELECT
uio p
CH SELECT
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit [ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 53
Quick Select Function
With this function, the currently playing input source, input mode, surround mode, room EQ settings and volume can be stored in the memory.
1
Set the input source, input mode, surround mode,
room EQ settings and volume to the conditions you want to store.
2
Press and hold the desired QUICK SELECT.
Keep pressing the button until the quick select indicator lights.
• To call out the settings, press QUICK SELECT at which the desired
settings were stored.
• The Quick Select name can be changed (vpage 32).
NOTE
Input sources stored with the quick select function cannot be selected if they have been deleted at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Source Delete” (vpage 31). In this case, store them again.
Input Source Volume Quick Select 1 DVD –40 dB Quick Select 2 TV/CBL –40 dB Quick Select 3 VCR –40 dB
[Quick Select Defaults]
Personal Memory Plus Function
This function sets the settings (input mode, surround mode, etc.) last selected for the individual input sources. When you switch to an input source, the settings are automatically set to the ones that were set the last time that input source was used.
The surround parameters, tone control, room EQ settings and the volumes of the different speakers are stored for the individual surround modes.
Last Function Memory
This stores the settings as they were directly before the standby mode was set. When the power is turned back on, the settings are restored to as they were directly before the standby mode was set.
Backup Memory
The various settings are backed up for about 1 week, even if the power is turned off or the power cord is disconnected.
1
Press CH SELECT.
2
Press ui or CH SELECT to select “Fader”.
3
Use o p to adjust the volume of the speakers.
(o: front, p: rear)
• The fader function does not affect the subwoofer.
• The fader can be adjusted until the volume of the speaker adjusted to the lowest value is –12 dB.
Fader Function
This function lets you adjust (fade) the sound from all the front or rear speakers at once.
Convenient Functions
1
Press CH SELECT.
Channel Volume
FL 0.0dBSR 0.0
dB
C 0.0dB SBR 0.0
dB
FR 0.0dB SBL 0.0
dB
SW 0.0dB SL 0.0
dB
Fader FRONT : REAR
2
Use ui or CH SELECT to select the speaker.
The speaker that can be set switches each time one of the buttons is pressed.
3
Use o p to adjust the volume.
b “OFF” can be set by pressing o when the subwoofer’s volume is
set to –12 dB.
Channel Level
You can adjust the channel level either according to the playback sources or to suit your taste, as described below.
Resetting the Microprocessor
Perform this procedure if the display is abnormal or if operations cannot be performed. When the microprocessor is reset, all the settings are reset to their default values.
1
Turn off the power using <POWER>.
2
Press <POWER> while simultaneously pressing
<STANDARD> and <DSP SIMULATION>.
3
Once the display starts ashing at intervals of about 1
second, release the two buttons.
If in step 3 the display does not flash at intervals of about 1 second, start over from step 1.
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 54
Remote Control Unit Operations
Main Remote Control Unit
• On the main remote control unit, the display switches according
to the device being operated and the mode.
• In modes other than iPod, the mode switches between“
and “ ” each time the [MODE SELECTOR] is pressed.
• In the AMP, TUNER and iPod modes, when the remote ID is
set, the AVR-2808CI can be used independently even in an environment containing multiple DENON amplifiers.
Depending on the model and year of manufacture of your equipment, some buttons may not operate.
NOTE
The device mode (“ ” or “ ”) cannot be changed while the setting is being made.
Operating DENON Audio Components
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the component to be
operated.
The indicator for the component to be operated flashes.
: AMP / ZONE2 / ZONE3 /
ZONE4 / SYSTEM CALL
: TUNER (FM/AM) / XM
: NET/USB /
DIGITAL TUNER
: Satellite Receiver / Cable TV
: iPod
: DVD player (Recorder) /
CD player (Recorder)
: VCR / TAPE
: TV
b The NET/DTU (
and ) mode is not used on the AVR-
2808CI, so use the learn function to store the signals (vpage
54).
b The mode switches each time [AMP] is pressed.
G
AMP modeH GZONE2 modeH GZONE3 modeH
GSYSTEM CALL modeH GZONE4 modeH
b The AVR-2808CI cannot be used in the ZONE4 mode.
2
Operate the component.
b For details, refer to the component’s operating instructions.
[HOME] is used to return to the AMP mode (AMP, ZONE2, ZONE3, ZONE4 or SYSTEM CALL) when in any mode other than AMP.
Presetting
The included main remote control unit can be preset to operate devices of various brands.
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
preset.
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [NUMBER] and input the 5-digit number of the
brand of the component to be preset. The numbers are shown in the Preset Code Table (vEnd of this manual).
When the code is registered, the signal transmission indicator flashes twice. When the preset code is transmitted, the mode indicator for the component to which that code belongs flashes.
b The input mode is canceled if no button is operated for 10
seconds.
Some brands have more than one preset code. If the component does not operate, try inputting a different code.
Operating Preset Components
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the component to be
operated.
The mode indicator of the device to be operated flashes.
2
Operate the component.
b For details, refer to the component’s operating instructions.
[ AMP]
[NUMBER]
[MODE SELECTOR]
[RC SETUP]
Signal transmission indicator

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 55
[MENU]
[CH + /
SHUFFLE],
[CH – /
REPEAT]
[SETUP/
SEARCH]
[ENTER]
[RETURN]
[0 ~ 9, +10]
[uiop]
[1], [8 9], [6 7], [3], [2], [SOURCE ON], [SOURCE OFF]
EL Display
MODE SELECTOR DVD VCR iPod
Device Mode
Device operated
DVD
(Default setting)
DVD Recorder
CD
(Default setting)
CD Recorder VCR TAPE iPod
1
Playback Playback Playback Playback Playback Playback Playback/Pause
8 9
Auto search
(cue)
Auto search
(cue)
Auto search
(cue)
Auto search
(cue)
Auto search
(cue)
Auto search
(cue)
Auto search
(cue)
6 7
Manual search
(fast-reverse/ fast-forward)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/ fast-forward)
3
Pause Pause Pause Pause Pause Pause
2
Stop Stop Stop Stop Stop Stop Stop
SOURCE ON Power on Power on Power on SOURCE OFF Power off Power off Power off
Buttons
MENU Menu/guide Menu/guide Menu/guide Menu
u i o p
Cursor Cursor Cursor Cursor
ENTER Enter setting Enter setting Enter setting Enter
SETUP/SEARCH Set up Set up Set up
Page forward
screen / Browse/
Remote mode
switching (Press
and hold)
RETURN Return Return Cancel Return
CH + / SHUFFLE Switch channels
1-track/album
shuffle play
CH - / REPEAT Switch channels
1-track/All-track
repeat play
0 ~ 9, +10 Select track Select track Select track Select track
Special Remarks
q, w q q q
Functions of Buttons by Component
GSpecial RemarksH
q Only one component can be preset for each mode. If a new code is preset, the previous code is automatically cleared. w The names of the functions for the DVD remote control buttons differ from brand to brand. Check beforehand.
NOTE
• Preset a DVD player or DVD recorder for the DVD ( ) mode. Preset a CD player or CD recorder for the DVD ( ) mode.
• Preset a VCR for the VCR ( ) mode. Preset a tape deck for the VCR ( ) mode.
EL Display
Buttons

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 56

[MENU]
[CH +/–]
[TV/VCR]
[ENTER]
[DISPLAY]
[0 ~ 9, +10]
[uiop]
[SETUP]
[1], [8 9], [6 7], [3], [2], [SOURCE ON], [SOURCE OFF]
EL Display
MODE SELECTOR TV Satellite Receiver / Cable TV
Device Mode
Device operated TV (HITACHI) TV (SONY) SAT SAT
1
Punch through Punch through Punch through Punch through
8 9
6 7
3 2
SOURCE ON Power on Power on Power on Power on
SOURCE OFF Power off Power off Power off Power off
Buttons
MENU Menu/guide Menu/guide Menu/guide Menu/guide
u i o p
Cursor Cursor Cursor Cursor
ENTER Enter setting Enter setting Enter setting Enter setting SETUP Set up Set up Set up Set up
DISPLAY Display Display Display Display
CH + / – Switch channels Switch channels Switch channels Switch channels
0 ~ 9, +10 Channel selection Channel selection Channel selection Channel selection
TV/VCR Switch inputs Switch inputs
Special Remarks
q, e q, e q, e q, e
GSpecial RemarksH
q Only one component can be preset for each mode. If a new code is preset, the previous code is automatically cleared. e The CD, VCR or DVD buttons (one only set) can be assigned to the monitor, satellite receiver and cable TV (vpage 55 “Punch Through
Function”).
EL Display
Buttons
[CH +/–]
[SEARCH]
[SHIFT]
[A ~ G], [d f], [BAND], [MODE], [MEMO]
[ENTER]
[0 ~ 9]
[uiop]
EL Display
MODE SELECTOR TU
Device Mode
Device operated Analog tuner XM
A ~ G Preset memory block selection Preset memory block selection
d f
Tuning + / – Channel selection
BAND AM/FM switching MODE Switch search modes MEMO Preset memory registration Preset memory registration
Buttons
u i o p
Category search
ENTER
SEARCH Direct search
CH + / – Preset channel selection Preset channel selection
0 ~ 9 Preset channel selection (1 ~ 8)
Preset channel selection (1 ~ 8) /
Direct channel search (0 ~ 9)
SHIFT Switch memory block Switch memory block
EL Display
Buttons

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 57
MODE
SELECTOR
Remote ID
AMP (MAIN)
TUNER
iPod
(Analog
TUNER)
(XM)
1
(Default)
81001 52863 52864 72815
2 82001 52795 52812 72816
3 83001 52800 52813 72817
4
84001 52805
52814
72818
Setting the Remote ID
When using multiple DENON AV receivers in the same room, make this setting so that only the desired AV receiver operates.
1
Press [AMP] to set the main remote control unit to the
AMP mode.
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Refer to the table at the right, and use [NUMBER] to
input the 5-digit number corresponding to the remote ID to be changed.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
4
Press [TU] or [iPod] to select the mode to be set.
5
Repeat steps 2 to 4 to set the remote IDs for all
modes.
NOTE
• When changing a setting, be sure to set the same remote ID as the
AVR-2808CI’s (vpage 32).
• When changing the AMP mode’s remote ID, also change the “TUNER” and “iPod” remote ID at the same time.
• Set the remote ID of an analog tuner for TUNER ( ), the XM remote ID for “
.
5
Point the main remote control units directly at each
other and press and hold the button on the other device’s remote control unit that you want to learn.
Once learning is completed normally, the display lights and the signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
b If you want to learn other buttons, repeat steps 4 and 5. b The mode can be switched by pressing [MODE SELECTOR]. b The signal transmission indicator lights once for a long time if
learning was not possible
6
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the setting is completed.
[ AMP]
[NUMBER]
[MODE SELECTOR]
[RC SETUP]
[ TU]
[ iPod]
Other device’s remote control unit
AVR-2808CI’s main remote control unit (RC-1068)
Learning Function
If your AV devices are of a brand other than DENON or if they cannot be operated with the preset memory function, their remote control signals can be transfered to stored in the AVR­2808CI’s main remote control unit.
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
set.
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [9], [7] and [5], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the learning mode is set.
4
Press the button to be set.
The main remote control unit’s display turns off.
b If a button that cannot be learned is pressed, the signal transmission
indicator lights but the signal is not learned.
With some remote control units, the signals cannot be learned or the device will not operate properly even when the signals have been learned. In this case, use the device’s own remote control unit.
• Learned buttons have priority over the preset memory. If you no longer need the learned setting, reset the learning function (vpage
56).
NOTE
[HOME] cannot be learned.
• Do not learn any remote control signals at [RC SETUP].
• The AMP, ZONE2, ZONE3, ZONE4 and SYSTEM CALL modes cannot be learned.
Signal transmission indicator

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 58
System Call Function
This function lets you register a series of operations at a single button. For example, the amplifier can be turned on, the input source selected, the monitor’s power turned on, the source device’s power turned on and the play mode set all by pressing a single button. Up to 32 signals each can be registered at [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3).
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
register.
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [9], [7] and [8], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the system call registration mode is set.
4
Press [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3) at which you want to
register the signals.
5
Press the buttons you want to register in the same
sequence as the operations you want to perform.
The signal transmission indicator lights when a button is pressed.
Example : Press [POWER ON]. Press [MODE SELECTOR] – [DVD].
Press [1]. b The mode can be switched by pressing [MODE SELECTOR]. b Perform the registration procedure for all the buttons you want to
register.
6
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the setting
is completed.
Calling out
1
Press [AMP], to select “SYSTEM CALL”.
2
Press [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3) at which the signals
were registered.
The registered signals are transmitted in the registered
sequence.
Setting the Time the Backlight Stays Lit
1
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
2
Press [9], [7] and [3], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the backlight on time setting mode is set.
3
Set the light on time.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
[Settable times] : [1] : 5 sec. [2] : 10 sec. (Default) [3] : 15 sec. [4] : 20 sec. [5] : 25 sec.
Registering
Punch Through Function
CD, DVD or VCR mode buttons can be stored at unused TV or SAT/CBL mode buttons. For example, when DVD mode buttons are assigned to the TV mode, the DVD mode operations can be performed while in the TV mode.
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
punch through (CD, DVD or VCR).
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [9], [8] and [4], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the punch through setting mode is set.
4
Press the button you want to punch through (1, 2,
6, 7, 8, 9 or 3).
5
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
punch through (TV or SAT/CBL).
6
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the setting is completed.
[NUMBER]
[RC SETUP]
[MODE
SELECTOR]
[ AMP]
[POWER
ON]
[SYSTEM
CALL]
[CHANNEL
+/–]
[8], [9], [6], [7], [1], [3], [2]
Signal
transmission
indicator

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 59
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
reset.
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [9], [7] and [6], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
4
Press the button you want to reset twice.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Resetting the Main Remote Control Unit
Learning Function
GResetting button by buttonH
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
reset.
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [9], [7] and [6], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
4
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
reset twice.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
GResetting by device modeH
1
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
2
Press [9], [7] and [8], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3) you want to reset.
4
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
reset (TV or SAT/CBL).
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [9], [8] and [4], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
4
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
1
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
2
Press [9], [8] and [1], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes 4 times.
All the settings are restored to their defaults.
System call function
Punch-through function
All settings
Adjusting the Backlight’s Brightness
The display’s brightness can be adjusted in 5 steps. (Default: Step 3)
1
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
2
Press [CHANNEL +] or [CHANNEL –].
The display gets one step brighter when [+] is pressed. The display gets one step darker when [–] is pressed.
3
Press [RC SETUP] to complete the setting.
Sub Remote Control Unit
The sub remote control unit (RC-1071) included with the AVR­2808CI can be used as the exclusive multi-zone remote control unit. b The following describes operation for the selected zone. (Use
[ZONE SELECT] to switch zones.)
• Turning the multi-zone power on and off
• Selecting the input source to be played
• Adjusting and temporarily muting the multi-zone volume
• Listening to the tuner

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
[CHANNEL+ / –]
[POWER OFF]
[REPEAT]
[POWER ON]
[RANDOM]
[SHIFT]
[MUTE]
[VOLUME+ / –]
[SOURCE SELECT]
[ZONE SELECT]
[TUNING+ / –]
[8],[9],
[1/3],[2]
ZONE SELECT Switching the zone to be operated
POWER OFF Power off
POWER ON Power on
SOURCE SELECT Switching the input zone
VOLUME + / - Volume control
CHANNEL + / - Channel + / –
TUNING + / - Tuning + / –
MUTE Muting SHIFT Switching the memory block
8 9
Auto search (cue)
2
Stop
1/3
Play / Pause
REPEAT 1-track / All -track repeat play
RANDOM 1-track / album shuffle play
b When using a Control Dock for iPod (ASD-1R), [FAVORITES DIRECT
PLAY] cannot be used.
Page 60

Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations
The AVR-2808CI is compatible with the following types of playback:
Multi-zone playback (ZONE2 & ZONE3)
Bi-amp playback (front speakers)
NOTE
• For bi-amp playback, use speakers compatible with that type of connection.
• When conducting bi-amp playback, remove the short-circuiting boards (or wires) from the speaker terminals.
Multi-zone Settings with the Amp Assign Function
The amp assign function lets you assign the amplifiers for the different channels built into the AVR-2808CI to the speaker outputs for the different zones. Select the desired playback environment from among “Setting 1” to “Setting 4”, then set the corresponding “Amp Assign” mode at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Amp Assign” (vpage 31). Connect the speakers as described at “Amp Assign mode settings and speakers connected to the various speaker terminals”.
Z2L Z2R
Z2L Z2R
Z2
ZONE2/3-MONO
FL
SW C FR
SL SR
Main zone
ZONE2
Stereo
Mono
5.1ch
ZONE2
Setting 1 :
F Multi-zone playback
• 5.1-channel playback + ZONE2 or ZONE3 stereo playback
• 5.1-channel playback + ZONE2 + ZONE3 monaural playback
Amp Assign mode:
“STEREO” or “MONO” depends on the setting at menu “Manual Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Zone Setup” – “Channel” (vpage 30).
n Amp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker
terminals
Z3L Z3R
Z3L Z3R
Z3
ZONE3
Stereo
Mono
+
+
+
+
+
+
ZONE3
(Default)
“Setting 3” is possible to switch the Amp Assign mode between the 5.1-channel mode and 2-channel mode without changing the speaker connections.
Speaker terminal
Amp Assign mode
FRONT
CENTER
SURR
SURR. BACK / AMP ASSIGN
R L R L R L
ZONE2
FR FL C SR SL
Z2R Z2L
ZONE3 Z3R Z3L
ZONE2/3-MONO
Z3
(MONO)
Z2
(MONO)

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 61
SBL SBR
FL
SW C FR
SL SR
Main zone
7.1ch
Setting 2 :
F 7.1-channel playback
n Amp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker
terminals
Setting 3 : With this setting it is possible to switch between the following two playback modes.
F 5.1-channel playback F 2-channel playback
Switching ················Surround Mode switching
Surround Mode
DIRECT / STEREO
Multi Channel /
Surround
FL
C FR
SW
L R
SL SR
Main zone
5.1ch
FL
C FR
SW
L R
SL SR
Main zone
2ch
2ch
n Amp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker
terminals
Speaker terminal
Amp Assign mode
FRONT
CENTER
SURR
SURR. BACK / AMP ASSIGN
R L R L R L
2ch FR FL C SR SL FR FL
Amp Assign mode:
Speaker terminal
Amp Assign mode
FRONT
CENTER
SURR
SURR. BACK /
AMP ASSIGN
R L R L R L
7.1ch FR FL C SR SL SBR SBL
7.1ch
Amp Assign mode:

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 62
$
'- 48 '3
4-
43
4#
3
4#
-
ZONE3 audio output
Main zone (7.1-channel system)
Monitor
ZONE2
ZONE3
DVD player
Input
Remote control unit
ZONE2 audio output
ZONE2 video output
AVR-2808CI
Monitor
Power amplifier
Power amplifier
: Multi-zone video cable : Multi-zone audio cable
• When only using one speaker for ZONE2 or ZONE3, set to “Mono”. In this case, the ZONE2 (ZONE3) monaural output is output from the ZONE2 (ZONE3) pre-out L and R connectors, so connect as desired.
• Separate power amplifiers are needed for ZONE2 and ZONE3.
Connectors for audio output Audio signals Connectors for video output
ZONE2 ZONE2 PRE OUT Stereo ZONE2 VIDEO OUT
ZONE3 ZONE3 PRE OUT Stereo
Multi-zone Settings and Operations with Zone Pre-out Output
Prepare power amplifiers for ZONE2 and ZONE3.
Remote control unit
Setting 4 :
F Making bi-amp connections for the FL and FR channels in the main zone
and conducting 5.1-channel playback
(switching with other modes not possible)
Speaker terminal
Amp Assign mode
FRONT-A FRONT-B
CENTER
SURR
SURR. BACK / AMP
ASSIGN
R L R L R L R L
Front A Bi-Amp
FR-A FL-A FR-B FL-B C SR SL
FR FL
Front B Bi-Amp
FR FL
FL-A/FR-A Bi-Amp
connection
FL-B/FR-B Bi-Amp
connection
FL
SW C FR
SL SR
Main zone
5.1ch
FL/FR
Bi-Amp
Front A Bi-Amp
Amp Assign mode:
n Amp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker
terminals
Front B Bi-Amp

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 63
Multi-zone Operations
Turning the Power On and Off
GOperation on the main unitH
Press <ZONE2 ON/OFF> or <ZONE3 ON/OFF> for the zone to be operated. When the power turns on, the multi-zone indicator ( or ) lights on the display.
GOperation on the remote control unitH
In the zone mode you want to operate, press [ON] or [OFF].
Selecting the Input Source
GOperation on the main unitH
q Press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT> and select the zone to be adjusted. w Turn <SOURCE SELECT>.
GOperation on the remote control unitH
In the zone mode you want to operate, press [SOURCE SELECT].
Adjusting the Volume
GOperation on the main unitH
q Press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT> and select the zone to be adjusted. w Turn <VOLUME> to adjust.
GOperation on the remote control unitH
In the zone mode whose volume you want to adjust, press [VOLUME].
– – – –70dB
~
–40dB
~
+18dB[Variable range]
The volume can be adjusted when menu “Manual Setup” – “Zone Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Volume Level” is set to “VAR”. The volume can be increased up to the value set at menu “Manual Setup” – “Zone Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Volume Limit” (vpage 30).
<ZONE2/3 / RECSELECT>
<ZONE2 ON/OFF>
<ZONE3 ON/OFF>
SOURCE SELECT
VOLUME
Turning off the Sound Temporarily
In the zone mode for which you want to mute the sound, press [MUTE]. The sound is reduced to the level set at menu “Manual Setup” – “Zone Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Mute Level” (vpage 30). To cancel, either adjust the volume or press [MUTE] again. The setting is canceled when the zone’s power is turned off.
The source selected for ZONE2 is also output from the recording output connectors.
NOTE
• When the input source to which the digital input connectors (OPTICAL/COAXIAL) are assigned is selected in ZONE2 or ZONE3, playback is only possible if the digital signal being input is in PCM (2-channel) format.
• Digital audio signals input from the HDMI connectors cannot be played in multi-zone.
• When certain digital signals are being input, noise may be output from the ZONE2 and ZONE3 audio output connectors.
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit [ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
[OFF]
[ON]
[MUTE]
VOLUME
SOURCE SELECT
(Sub remote control unit)
[MUTE]
SOURCE
SELECT
[ON]
[OFF]
VOLUME
[ AMP]
[ON] [OFF]
(ZONE3 mode)
(ZONE2 mode)
(Main remote control unit)
Page 64
Surround back speakers
Sound positioning directly to the rear can be achieved easily by adding a surround back speaker to a 5.1-channel system. In addition, the acoustic image extending between the sides and the rear is narrowed, thus greatly improving the expression of the surround signals for sounds moving from the sides to the back and from the front to the point directly behind the listening position.
'- $48'3
43DI4-DI
Change of positioning and acoustic image
with 5.1-channel systems
Movement of acoustic image from SR to SL
'- $48'3
4-DI 43DI
4#DI
Change of positioning and acoustic image
with 6.1-channel systems
Movement of acoustic image from SR to SB to SL
In addition to sources recorded in 6.1-channels, the surround effect of conventional 2- to 5.1-channel sources can also be enhanced.
Number of surround back speakers
We recommend using 2 speakers. When using dipolar speakers in particular, be sure to use 2 speakers.
Placement of the surround left and right channels when using surround back speakers
We recommend installing the speakers for the surround “L” and “R” channels a bit forward.
Examples of speaker layouts
Below we introduce examples of speaker layouts. Refer to these to arrange your speakers according to their type and how you want to use them.
G1H Using surround back speaker(s)
q When mainly playing movies
Recommended when your surround speakers are single or 2-way speakers.
Surround back speakers
Subwoofer
Surround speakers
Monitor
Center speaker
Front speakers
60°
60°
Surround speaker
Surround back
speaker
Front speaker
Point slightly downwards
G
As seen from above
H G
As seen from the side
H
2 to 3 feet /
60 to 90 cm
Other Information
About Speaker Installation
w Setting for primarily watching movies using diffusion type
speakers for the surround speakers
For the greatest sense of surround sound envelopment, diffuse radiation speakers such as bipolar types, or dipolar types, provide a wider dispersion than is possible to obtain from a direct radiating speaker (monopolar). Place these speakers at either side of the prime listening position, mounted above ear level.
Surround speakers
60°
Surround back speakers
Surround speaker
Surround back
speaker
Front speaker
2 to 3 feet /
Point slightly downwards
60 to 90 cm
G
As seen from above
H G
As seen from the side
H
Path of the surround sound from the speakers to the listening position
e When playing movies and music
Center speaker
Front speakers
Subwoofer
Monitor
45° ~ 60°
Surround back
speaker
Surround speaker
Surround speaker
Surround back
speaker
Front speaker
Point slightly downwards
2 to 3 feet /
60 to 90 cm
G
As seen from above
H G
As seen from the side
H

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 65
G2H When not using surround back speakers
Subwoofer
Surround speakers
Monitor
Center speaker
Front speakers
60°
120°
2 to 3 feet /
60 to 90 cm
Front speaker
Surround speaker
G
As seen from above
H G
As seen from the side
H
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital is a multichannel digital signal format developed by Dolby Laboratories. A total of 5.1-channels are played: 3 front channels (“FL” , “FR” and “C”), 2 surround channels (“SL” and “SR”) and the “LFE” channel for low frequencies. Because of this, there is no crosstalk between channels and a realistic sound field with a “three-dimensional” feeling (sense of distance, movement and positioning) is achieved. A real, overpowering sense of presence is achieved when playing movie sources in AV rooms as well.
Surround
Dolby Surround
The AVR-2808CI is equipped with a digital signal processing circuit that lets you play program sources in the surround mode to achieve the same sense of presence as in a movie theater.
Dolby Pro Logic g
Dolby Pro Logic g is a matrix decoding technology developed by Dolby Laboratories. Regular music such as that on CDs is encoded into 5-channels to achieve an excellent surround effect. The surround channel signals are converted into stereo and full band signals (with a frequency response of 20 Hz to 20 kHz or greater) to create a “three-dimensional” sound image offering a rich sense of presence for all stereo sources.
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital Plus is an improved Dolby Digital signal format that is compatible with up to 7.1-channels of discrete digital sound and also improves sound quality thanks to extra data bit rate performance. It is upwardly compatible with conventional Dolby Digital, so it offers greater flexibility in response to the source signal and the conditions of the playback equipment.
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD is a high definition audio technology developed by Dolby Laboratories, using lossless coding technology to faithfully reproduce the sound of the studio master. This format is compatible with a maximum sampling frequency of 96 kHz and up to 7.1-channels, so it is used for applications particularly prioritizing sound quality.
Dolby Pro Logic gx
Dolby Pro Logic gx is a further improved version of the Dolby Pro Logic g matrix decoding technology.
Audio signals recorded in 2-channels are decoded to achieve a natural sound with up to 7.1-channels. There are 3 modes: “Music” suited for playing music, “Cinema” suited for playing movies, and “Game” which is optimized for playing games.
b Sources recorded in Dolby Surround
Sources recorded in Dolby Surround are indicated with the following logo marks. Dolby Surround support mark :
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. “Dolby”, “Pro Logic” and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
DTS Surround
DTS Digital Surround
DTS Digital Surround is the standard digital surround format of DTS, Inc., compatible with a sampling frequency of 44.1 or 48 kHz and up to 5.1-channels of digital discrete surround sound.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is an improved version of the conventional DTS, DTS-ES and DTS 96/24 signals formats, compatible with sampling frequencies of 96 or 48 kHz and up to 7.1-channels of discrete digital sound. High data bit rate performance provides high quality sound. This format is fully compatible with conventional products, including conventional DTS digital surround 5.1-channel data.
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio is DTS, Inc’s lossless audio format compatible with up to 96 kHz/7.1-channels. The lossless audio coding technology faithfully reproduces the sound of the studio master. It is fully compatible with conventional products, including conventional DTS digital surround 5.1-channel data.
DTS-ES™ Discrete 6.1
DTS-ES™ Discrete 6.1 is a 6.1-channel discrete digital audio format adding a surround back (SB) channel to the DTS digital surround sound. Decoding of conventional 5.1-channel audio signals is also possible according to the decoder.
DTS-ES™ Matrix 6.1
DTS-ES™ Matrix 6.1 is a 6.1-channel discrete digital audio format inserting a surround back (SB) channel to the DTS digital surround sound through matrix encoding. Decoding of conventional 5.1-channel audio signals is also possible according to the decoder.
DTS NEO:6™ Surround
DTS NEO:6™ is a matrix decoding technology for achieving 6.1­channel surround playback with 2-channel sources. It includes “DTS NEO:6 CINEMA” suited for playing movies and “DTS NEO:6 MUSIC” suited for playing music.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 66
DTS 96/24
DTS 96/24 is a digital audio format enabling high sound quality playback in 5.1-channels with a sampling frequency of 96 kHz and 24 bit quantization on DVD-Video.
Neural Surround™, a breakthrough in audio technology, will bring the excitement of surround music to more of America’s listening audience. It provides the rich envelopment and discrete image detail of surround sound in a format 100 % compatible with stereo. With superior spectral resolution and channel separation, Neural Surround™ draws the brain’s attention to sonic details in musical instruments, vocals, and ambience that are typically masked by other playback systems. This allows the listener to fully experience the richness and subtleties in recorded performance as never before. As the chosen format for XM Satellite Radio’s new XM HD surround programming, Neural Surround will help deliver more surround music to more listeners than any other broadcast format. XM Satellite Radio will be the first radio company to broadcast surround sound on the radio 24 hours a day and will offer three channels fully dedicated to Neural Surround™ music. This alone will amount to more than 25,000 hours of Neural Surround™ music each year.
Neural Surround
This product is manufactured under license from Neural Audio Corporation. D&M Holdings Inc. hereby grants the user a non-exclusive, nontransferable, limited license right exercisable to use the NA SURROUND Technology and other US and World Wide Patents Pending technology. “Neural” and “Neural Audio” and “Neural Surround” are trademarks of Neural Audio Corporation. All Rights Reserved.
AL24 Processing Plus
AL24 Processing for All Channels
DENON has further developed its proprietary AL24 Processing, an analog waveform reproduction technology, to support the 192-kHz sampling frequency of DVD-Audio. AL24 Processing Plus, thoroughly suppresses quantization noise associated with D/A conversion of LPCM signals to reproduce the low-level signals with optimum clarity that will bring out all the delicate nuances of the music. Equipped foe not only front left and right channels but also for the surround left and right, center and subwoofer channels.
Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent #’s: 5,451,942; 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762; 6,226,616; 6,487,535 & other U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS is a registered trademark and the DTS logos, Symbol, DTS-HD and DTS-HD Master Audio are trademarks of DTS, Inc.© 1996-2007 DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface)
HDMI is a digital interface standard for next generation TVs based on DVI (Digital Visual Interface) standards and optimized for use in consumer equipment. Non-compressed digital video and multi-channel audio signals are transmitted with a single connection. HDMI is also compatible with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Contents Protection), a technology for protecting copyrights that encrypts digital video signals in the same was as with DVI.
“HDMI”, “HDMI logo” and “High-Definition Multimedia Interface” are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.
Deep Color
Eliminates on-screen color banding, for smooth tonal transitions and subtle gradations between colors. Enables increased contrast ratio. Can represent many times more shades of gray between black and white. At 30-bit pixel depth, a four times improvement would be the minimum, and the typical improvement would be eight times or more.
xvYCC
Next-generation “xvYCC” color space supports 1.8 times as many colors as existing HDTV signals. Lets HDTVs display colors more accurately. Enables displays with natural, vivid colors.
Lip Sync
Because consumer electronics devices are using increasingly complex digital signal processing to enhance the clarity and detail of the content, synchronization of video and audio in user devices has become a greater challenge and could potentially require complex end­user adjustments. HDMI 1.3 incorporates an automatic video/audio synching capability that allows devices to perform this synchronization automatically with total accuracy.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Audyssey MultEQ® XT is the first technology to properly measure sound information throughout a listening area, then combine this information to accurately represent the acoustical problems in the room. Based on these measurements, MultEQ XT calculates an equalization solution that corrects for both time and frequency response problems in every seat. Audyssey MultEQ XT not only corrects frequency response problem in a large listening area, it also performs a fully automated surround system setup. For a detailed description, see page 23.
Audyssey MultEQ® XT
Audyssey MultEQ® XT is a trademark of Audyssey Laboratories. It is licensed under US and National Patent Applications 20030235318 and 10/700,220. Additional U.S. and Foreign Patents pending. MultEQ XT and the Audyssey MultEQ XT logo are trademarks of Audyssey Laboratories, Inc. All rights reserved.
Page 67
Surround mode
Signals and adjustability in the different modes
Channel output Parameter (default values are shown in parentheses)
Front L/R Center
Surround
L/R
Surround Back L/R
Subwoofer
D. COMP
z
1
LFE
z
2
AFDM
z
1
SB CH OUT
CINEMA
EQ.
PURE DIRECT, DIRECT
S A A A D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A A A
DSD DIRECT
S A A A A A A A A A
DSD MULTI DIRECT
S D D D D A S ( 0 dB) A S A
MULTI CH DIRECT
S D D D D A S ( 0 dB) S (ON) S A
STEREO
S A A A D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A A A
EXT. IN
S D D D D A A A A A
MULTI CH IN
S D D D D A S ( 0 dB) S (ON) S A
WIDE SCREEN
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S S (OFF) DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx S D D D D S (OFF) A A S S (NOTE1) DOLBY PRO LOGIC g S D D A D S (OFF) A A S S (NOTE2)
DTS NEO:6
S D D D D S (OFF) A A S S (NOTE1)
DOLBY DIGITAL
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) S (ON) S S (OFF)
DTS SURROUND
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) S (ON) S S (OFF)
neural
S D D D D A A A S A
7CH STEREO
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
SUPER STADIUM
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
ROCK ARENA
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
JAZZ CLUB
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
CLASSIC CONCERT
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
MONO MOVIE
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
VIDEO GAME
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
MATRIX
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
VIRTUAL
S A A A D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A A A
S : Signal / Adjustable A : No signal / Not adjustable D : Turned on or off by speaker configuration setting
NOTE1 : This parameter is availabe when the menu “Parameter” – “Surround Parameter” – “MODE” is set to “CINEMA” (
vpage 38).
NOTE2 : This parameter is availabe when the menu “Parameter” – “Surround Parameter” – “MODE” is set to “CINEMA” or “PL” (
vpage
38).
NOTE:
z
1 : When playing Dolby Digital and DTS signals.
z
2 : When playing Dolby Digital, DTS, DVD-Audio and Super Audio CD.
Surround Modes and Parameters

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 68
Surround mode
Signals and adjustability in the different modes
Parameter (default values are shown in parentheses)
MODE ROOM SIZE LEVEL DELAY TIME Subwoofer
PRO LOGIC g/gx MUSIC mode only
NEO:6 MUSIC
mode only
EXT. IN only
Tone Control Night Mode Room EQ RESTORER
PANORAMA DIMENSION
CENTER
WIDTH
CENTER
IMAGE
SUBWOOFER
ATT.
PURE DIRECT, DIRECT
A A A A S A A A A A A S (OFF) S (NOTE5) S
DSD DIRECT
A A A A S A A A A A A A A A
DSD MULTI DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A A A A
MULTI CH DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A S (OFF) S (NOTE5) A
STEREO
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
EXT. IN
A A A A A A A A A S A A A A
MULTI CH IN
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) A
WIDE SCREEN
A A S (ON, 10) A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx S (CINEMA) A A A A S (OFF) S (3) S (3) A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S DOLBY PRO LOGIC g S (CINEMA) A A A A S (OFF) S (3) S (3) A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
DTS NEO:6
S (CINEMA) A A A A A A A S (0.3) A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
DOLBY DIGITAL
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) A
DTS SURROUND
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) A
neural
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
7CH STEREO
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
SUPER STADIUM
A S (medium) S (10) A A A A A A A S (NOTE3) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
ROCK ARENA
A S (medium) S (10) A A A A A A A S (NOTE4) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
JAZZ CLUB
A S (medium) S (10) A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
CLASSIC CONCERT
A S (medium) S (10) A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
MONO MOVIE
A S (medium) S (10) A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
VIDEO GAME
A S (medium) S (10) A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
MATRIX
A A A S (30 ms) A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
VIRTUAL
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
S : Signal / Adjustable A : No signal / Not adjustable
NOTE3 : BASS +6 dB, TREBLE 0 dB NOTE4 : BASS +6 dB, TREBLE +4 dB NOTE5 : Can be used according to the “Direct Mode” setting.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 69
Button
Note
Input signals
ANALOG
LINEAR
PCM
DTS DOLBY DIGITAL DVD-AUDIO Super Audio CD
Surround mode
DTS ES
DSCRT
(With Flag)
DTS ES
MTRX
(With Flag)
DTS
(5.1ch)
DTS
96/24
DOLBY
DIGITAL EX
(With Flag)
DOLBY
DIGITAL EX
(With no
Flag)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(5.1/5/4ch)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(4/3ch)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(2ch)
DVD-Audio
(multi ch)
DVD-Audio
(2ch)
DSD
(multi ch)
DSD (2ch)
STANDARD
DTS SURROUND
DTS ES DSCRT6.1
z
1
A A F D A A A A A A A A A A A A
DTS ES MTRX6.1
z
1
A A A F D A A A A A A A A A A A
DTS SURROUND
A A S S F A A A A A A A A A A
DTS 96/24
A A A A A F A A A A A A A A A
DTS + PLgx CINEMA
z
2
A A S S S S A A A A A A A A A
DTS + PLgx MUSIC
z
1
A A S S S S A A A A A A A A A
DTS + NEO:6
z
1
A A A S S S A A A A A A A A A
DTS NEO:6 CINEMA
S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S
DTS NEO:6 MUSIC
S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S
DOLBY SURROUND
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
z
1
A A A A A A S S S S A A A A A
DOLBY DIGITAL
A A A A A A S F F F A A A A A
DOLBY DIGITAL + PLgx CINEMA
z
2
A A A A A A F D S S S A A A A A
DOLBY DIGITAL + PLgx MUSIC
z
1
A A A A A A S S S S A A A A A
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx CINEMA S S A A A A A A A A F A S A S DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx MUSIC S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx GAME S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S DOLBY PRO LOGIC g CINEMA S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S DOLBY PRO LOGIC g MUSIC S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S DOLBY PRO LOGIC g GAME S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC
S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S
neural
S S A A A A A A A A A A S A A
MULTI CH IN
MULTI CH IN
A A A A A A A A A A A F A F A
MULTI IN + PLgx CINEMA
z
2
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
MULTI IN + PLgx MUSIC
z
1
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
MULTI CH IN 7.1
A A A A A A A A A A A F D (7.1) A A A
F : Mode selectable in initial status D : Mode fixed when “AFDM” is “ON” S : Selectable mode A : Non-selectable mode
NOTE:
z
1: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “None”.
z
2: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “1spkr” or “None”.
Differences in Surround Mode Names Depending on the Input Signals

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 70
Button
Note
Input signals
ANALOG
LINEAR
PCM
DTS DOLBY DIGITAL DVD-AUDIO Super Audio CD
Surround mode
DTS ES
DSCRT
(With Flag)
DTS ES
MTRX
(With Flag)
DTS
(5.1ch)
DTS
96/24
DOLBY
DIGITAL EX
(With Flag)
DOLBY
DIGITAL EX
(With no
Flag)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(5.1/5/4ch)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(4/3ch)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(2ch)
DVD­Audio (multi
ch)
DVD-
Audio
(2ch)
DSD
(multi
ch)
DSD (2ch)
DIRECT
DIRECT
S S S S S S S S S S S A S A S
DSD DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A A A A S
DSD MULTI DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A A A S A
MULTI CH DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
M DIRECT + PLgx CINEMA
z
2
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
M DIRECT + PLgx MUSIC
z
1
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
M DIRECT 7.1
A A A A A A A A A A A S A A A
PURE DIRECT
PURE DIRECT
S S S S S S S S S S S A S A S
DSD PURE DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A A A A S
DSD MULTI PURE
A A A A A A A A A A A A A S A
MULTI CH PURE DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
M PURE D + PLgx CINEMA
z
2
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
M PURE D + PLgx MUSIC
z
1
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
M CH PURE DIRECT 7.1
A A A A A A A A A A A S A A A
DSP SIMULATION
7CH STEREO
z
3
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
WIDE SCREEN
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
SUPER STADIUM
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
ROCK ARENA
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
JAZZ CLUB
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
CLASSIC CONCERT
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
MONO MOVIE
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
VIDEO GAME
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
MATRIX
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
VIRTUAL
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
STEREO
STEREO
F F S S S S S S S S S S F S F
F : Mode selectable in initial status S : Selectable mode A : Non-selectable mode
NOTE :
z
1: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “None”.
z
2: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “1spkr” or “None”.
z
3: If the surround back speaker setup is set to “None”, then “5CH STEREO” is displayed.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 71
Relationship Between Video Signals and Monitor Output
Video convert
Input signals MONITOR OUT
HDMI COMPONENT S-VIDEO VIDEO HDMI COMPONENT S-VIDEO VIDEO
ON
A A A A A A A A A A A S
VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO
A A S A
S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A A S S
S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A S (1080p) A A A
COMPONENT
A A
A S (480p ~ 720p) A A
COMPONENT COMPONENT
A A
A S (480i / 576i) A A
COMPONENT COMPONENT COMPONENT COMPONENT
A S (1080p) A S
VIDEO COMPONENTz1 VIDEO VIDEO
A S (480p ~ 720p) A S
COMPONENTz1 COMPONENTz1
A
VIDEO
A S (480i / 576i) A S
COMPONENTz1 COMPONENTz1 COMPONENT VIDEO
A S (1080p) S A
S-VIDEO COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A S (480p ~ 720p) S A
COMPONENTz2 COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A S (480i / 576i) S A
COMPONENTz2 COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A S (1080p) S S
S-VIDEO COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A S (480p ~ 720p) S S
COMPONENTz2 COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A S (480i / 576i) S S
COMPONENTz2 COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S A A A
HDMI
A A A
S A A S
HDMIz1 VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO
S A S A
HDMIz2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S A S S
HDMIz2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S S (Other than 480i / 576i) A A
HDMI COMPONENT
A A
S S (480i / 576i) A A
HDMI COMPONENT COMPONENT COMPONENT
S S (1080p) A S
HDMIz1 COMPONENTz1 VIDEO VIDEO
S S (480p ~ 720p) A S
HDMIz1 COMPONENTz1
A
VIDEO
S S (480i / 576i) A S
HDMIz1 COMPONENTz1 COMPONENT VIDEO
S S (Other than 480i / 576i) S A
HDMIz2 COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S S (480i / 576i) S A
HDMIz2 COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S S (Other than 480i / 576i) S S
HDMIz2 COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S S (480i / 576i) S S
HDMIz2 COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S : Signal input A : No signal
480p ~ 720p: 480p / 576p / 1080i / 720p
A : Not output
z
1 : On-screen display superimposed on video signal and output.
z
2 : On-screen display superimposed on S-Video signal and output.
COMPONENT or HDMI :
On-screen display only displayed for MENU button and the main remote control unit’s PARA button.
• The main zone video conversion function is compatible with the following format: NTSC, PAL, SECAM, NTSC4.43, PAL-N, PAL-M and PAL-60.
• When SECAM signals of video input are up-converted, the signals are output in PAL format from the S-Video connector.
• When the input signal is a component 1080i or 720p signal, the signal upconverted to HDMI is output with that resolution or 1080p.
• When the input signal is a video, S-Video or component 480i, 480p, 576i or 576p signals, the signal up-converted to HDMI is output according to
the setting made at “Resolution” under “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI Video Setup” (vpage 28).
• Signals up-converted to HDMI are output to the HDMI monitor with the resolution at which they are input.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 72
Video convert
S-VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
Input signals MONITOR OUT
HDMI COMPONENT S-VIDEO VIDEO HDMI COMPONENT S-VIDEO VIDEO
OFF
A A A A A A A A
A A A S A A A
VIDEO
A A S A A A
S-VIDEO
A
Used
A A S S A A
S-VIDEO VIDEOz2
Not used
A A S S A A
VIDEO
A S A A A
COMPONENT
A A
A S A S A
COMPONENTz1
A
VIDEO
A S S A A
COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO
A
Used
A S S S A
COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO VIDEOz2
Not used
A S S S A
COMPONENTz1 VIDEO
S A A A
HDMI
A A A
S A A S
HDMI
A A
VIDEO
S A S A
HDMI
A
S-VIDEO
A
Used
S A S S
HDMI
A
S-VIDEO VIDEOz2
Not used
S A S S
HDMI
A
VIDEO
S S A A
HDMI COMPONENT
A A
S S A S
HDMI COMPONENTz1
A
VIDEO
S S S A
HDMI COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO
A
Used
S S S S
HDMI COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO VIDEOz2
Not used
S S S S
HDMI COMPONENTz1 VIDEO
S : Signal input A : No signal
A : Not output
z
1 : On-screen display superimposed on video signal and output.
z
2 : On-screen display superimposed on S-Video signal and output.
COMPONENT or HDMI :
On-screen display only displayed for MENU button and the main remote control unit’s PARA button.
Input
Monitor out
S-VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO
A A A A S S (VIDEO) S A S (S-VIDEO) S S S (S-VIDEO)
S : Output present A : No output
S : Signal present A : No signal
n ZONE2 monitor out

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 73
If a problem should arise, first check the following:
1. Are the connections correct?
2. Is the set being operated as described in the owners manual?
3. Are the other components operating properly?
If this unit does not operate properly, check the items listed in the table below. Should the problem persist, there may be a malfunction. In this case, disconnect the power immediately and contact your store of purchase.
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
Power does not turn on, or turns off directly after it was turned on.
• Connection of the power cord is faulty.
• Check that the power plugs are securely inserted into the AVR­2808CI’s AC inlets and the wall power outlet.
20
No sound is produced from speakers.
• Connection with the input devices or connection of the speaker cables is faulty.
• Device you want to play and set input source do not match.
• Master volume is turned too low.
• Mute mode is set.
• Headphones are connected.
• No digital signals are being input.
• The connectors to which the digital inputs are assigned and the settable input modes do not match.
• Check the connections.
• Select an appropriate input source.
• Adjust the master volume to an appropriate level.
• Cancel the mute mode.
• Disconnect the headphones.
• Select an input source for which the digital input setting has been made.
• Set the input mode.
9
43
43
43 43 35
34
Display is off. • The “Dimmer” setting is set to
“OFF”.
• The PURE DIRECT mode is set.
• Set to something other than “OFF”.
• Set a surround mode other than the PURE DIRECT mode.
32
38
“DOLBY DIGITAL” indicator does not appear on display.
• DVD player’s digital audio output setting is not proper.
• Check the DVD player’s audio output setting. For details, read the DVD player’s operating instructions.
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
Power turns off suddenly and power indicator flashes red.
• Protection circuit activated due to rise of internal temperature.
• Core wires of two speakers are touching each other or a core wire is sticking out of the terminal and touching the set’s rear panel, activating the protection circuit.
• Speakers with an impedance other than specified are being used.
• Set is damaged.
• Turn off the power, wait for the set to fully cool down, then turn the power back on.
• Place the set in a well-ventilated place.
• First unplug the power cord, then twist the core wires tightly or terminate the speaker cables, then reconnect.
• Use speakers with the specified impedance.
• Turn off the power and contact a DENON service center.
10
10
10
10
GGeneralH
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
Set does not work properly when remote control unit operated.
• Batteries are worn.
• You are operating outside of the specified range.
• Obstacle between main unit and remote control unit.
• The batteries are not inserted in the proper direction, as indicated by the polarity marks in the battery compartment.
• The set’s remote control sensor is exposed to strong light (direct sunlight, inverter type fluorescent bulb light, etc.).
• The remote ID of the main unit and remote control unit do not match.
• Replace with new batteries.
• Operate within the specified range.
• Remove the obstacle.
• Insert the batteries in the proper direction, following the polarity marks in the battery compartment.
• Move the set to a place in which the remote control sensor will not be exposed to strong light.
• Set the same remote IDs for the main unit and remote control unit.
3 3
3
3
3
54
GRemote Control UnitH
Troubleshooting
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 74
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
No sound is produced from center speaker.
• Monaural source (monitor, AM station, etc.) being played in STANDARD mode.
• The mode is set to something other than “STANDARD”.
37
No sound is produced from surround speakers.
• The surround mode is set to “STEREO”, “DIRECT” or “PURE DIRECT”.
• Set to a surround playback mode.
36, 37
No sound is produced from surround back speaker.
• The surround back speaker’s power amplifier is assigned to a different channel.
• Surround back speaker setting is set to “None”.
• Surround mode not set to a mode for 6.1- or 7.1-channel playback.
• Check the setting and change it as necessary.
• Set to something other than “None”.
• Select a surround playback mode.
31
26
36, 37
No sound is produced from subwoofer.
• Subwoofer’s power not turned on.
• The “Subwoofer” setting at “Speaker configuration” is set to “No”.
• The subwoofer is not properly connected.
• The subwoofer’s volume is turned off.
• Turn on the subwoofer’s power.
• Set to “Yes”.
• Check the connections.
• Adjust the subwoofer’s volume to an appropriate level.
26
9
50
No test tones are produced when main remote control unit’s TEST TONE button is pressed.
• Surround mode not set to “STANDARD”.
• Set to the STANDARD mode. 37
DTS sound is not output.
• DVD player’s audio output setting is not set to bitstream.
• DVD player is not compatible with DTS sound playback.
• The AVR-2808CI’s “Decode Mode” setting is set to “PCM”.
• Set the DVD player. For details, refer to the DVD player’s operating instructions.
• Use a DTS-compatible player.
• Set to the “Auto” or “DTS” mode.
34
HDMI audio signals are not output from speakers.
• The “Manual Setup” – “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup” – “HDMI Audio Out” setting is set to “TV”.
• Set to “AMP”. 27
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
No sound is output from the monitor connected with HDMI connections.
• The “Manual Setup” – “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup” – “HDMI Audio Out” setting is set to “AMP”.
• Set to “TV”. 27
GAudioH
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
No picture appears.
• The connections between the AVR-2808CI and monitor are faulty.
• The monitor’s input setting is wrong.
• PURE DIRECT mode is set.
• The player is connected using the component input connectors, the monitor is connected using the video (yellow) or S-Video output connectors.
• Check the connections.
• Set properly.
• Cancel the PURE DIRECT mode.
• High definition (1080i/720p) and progressive (480p/576p) video signals are not down-converted. Set the player to interlace (480i/576i) signals.
11 ~ 20
38
No picture appears with HDMI connections.
• The connections to the HDMI connectors are faulty.
• HDMI input setting is improper.
• The monitor is not compatible with copyright protection (HDCP).
• The HDMI format of the player and monitor do not match.
• Check the connections.
• Check the HDMI input setting.
• Connect a monitor that is compatible with copyright protection (HDCP).
• Match the HDMI format of the player and monitor.
11
35
11
11
Picture cannot be recorded.
• Input source does not match recorder’s video connection connector (video or S-Video).
• The video conversion function does not work for the REC OUT connectors. Match the input source and recorder connections.
15
DVDs cannot be copied on a VCR.
• This is not a malfunction. Most movie software includes copy prevention signals and cannot be copied.
GVideoH

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 75
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
iPod cannot be played.
• The input source assigned to “iPod dock” is not selected.
• Cable is not properly connected.
• Control Dock for iPod’s AC adapter is not connected to power outlet.
Switch to the input source assigned at “iPod dock”.
• Reconnect.
• Plug the Control Dock for iPod’s AC adapter into a power outlet.
36
14
GiPodH
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
”CHECK ANTENNA” is displayed in the XM mode.
• AVR-2808CI’s XM connector and the XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock is not properly connected.
• Check that the connections are correct.
18
”NO SIGNAL” is displayed in the XM mode.
• The signal cannot be received. • Reposition your XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock antenna.
46
”OFF AIR” is displayed in the XM mode.
• The selected channel is not
currently broadcasting.
• Select another channel. 45, 46
Receiving only XM channels 0 and 1.
• The XM Tuner is not activated. • Contact XM Radio. 45
GXM Satellite RadioH

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 76

Specifications
n
Audio section
• Power amplifier Rated output:
Front (A, B):
110 W + 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.) 140 W + 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Center: 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.) 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.) Surround: 110 W + 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.) 140 W + 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.) Surround Back: 110 W + 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.)
140 W + 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.) Dynamic power:
120 W x 2ch (8 Ω/ohms)
170 W x 2ch (4 Ω/ohms)
Output terminals: Front: A or B
6 ~ 16 Ω/ohms
A + B
8 ~ 16 Ω/ohms
Center, Surround, Surr. Back: 6 ~ 16 Ω/ohms
• Analog Input sensitivity / Input impedance:
200 mV / 47 kΩ/kohms
Frequency response:
10 Hz ~ 100 kHz — +1, –3 dB (DIRECT mode)
S/N:
102 dB (IHF-A weighted) (DIRECT mode)
Distortion:
0.005 % (20 Hz ~ 20 kHz) (DIRECT mode)
Rated output:
1.2 V
• Digital D/A output:
Rated output — 2 V (at 0 dB playback)
Total harmonic distortion — 0.008 % (1 kHz, at 0 dB) S/N ratio — 102 dB Dynamic range — 96 dB Digital input:
Format — Digital audio interface
• Phono equalizer (PHONO input — REC OUT) Input sensitivity:
2.5 mV
RIAA deviation:
±1 dB (20 Hz to 20 kHz)
S/N:
74 dB (A weighting, with 5 mV input)
Rated output:
150 mV
Distortion factor:
0.03 % (1 kHz, 3 V)
n
Video section
• Standard video terminals Input / output level and impedance:
1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
Frequency response:
5 Hz ~ 10 MHz — +0, –3 dB (when video convert set to “OFF”)
• S-Video terminals Input / output level and impedance:
Y (brightness) signal — 1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
C (color) signal — 0.286 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
Frequency response:
5 Hz ~ 10 MHz — +0, –3 dB (when video convert set to “OFF”)
• Color component video terminal Input / output level and impedance:
Y (brightness) signal — 1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
P
B / CB signal — 0.7 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
P
R / CR signal — 0.7 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
Frequency response:
5 Hz ~ 100 MHz — +0, –3 dB (when video convert set to “OFF”)
n
Tuner section [FM] [AM]
(note: µV at 75 Ω/ohms, 0 dBf = 1 x 10
-15
W)
Receiving Range: 87.5 MHz ~ 107.9 MHz 520 kHz ~ 1710 kHz Usable Sensitivity: 1.0 µV (11.2 dBf) 18 µV 50 dB Quieting Sensitivity: MONO 1.6 µV (15.3 dBf)
STEREO 23 µV (38.5 dBf) S/N (IHF-A): MONO 77 dB STEREO 72 dB Total harmonic Distortion (at 1 kHz): MONO 0.15 % STEREO 0.3 %
n
General
Power supply: AC 120 V, 60 Hz Power consumption:
6.0 A
0.3 W (Standby)
Maximum external dimensions:
434 (W) x 171 (H) x 420 (D) mm (17-3/32” x 6-47/64” x 16-17/32”)
Weight: 12.8 kg (28 lbs 3.5 oz)
n
Main remote control unit (RC-1068)
Batteries: LR6/AA Type (two batteries) Maximum external dimensions:
63 (W) x 238 (H) x 31 (D) mm (2-31/64” x 9-3/8” x 1-7/32”)
Weight: 190 g (Approx 6.7 oz) (including batteries)
n
Sub remote control unit (RC-1071)
Batteries: R03/AAA Type (two batteries) Maximum external dimensions:
54 (W) x 115 (H) x 23 (D) mm (2-1/8” x 4-17/32” x 29/32”)
Weight: 80 g (Approx 2.8 oz) (including batteries)
z For purposes of improvement, specifications and design are subject to change without notice.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Page 77
Denon Amp
D
Denon 81001, 82001, 83001, 84001
Denon Tuner
D
Denon (Analog) 52863, 52795, 52800, 52805 Denon (XM Radio) 52864, 52812, 52813, 52814
Denon iPod
D
Denon 72815, 72816, 72817, 72818
Cable
A
A-Mark 00008, 00144 ABC 00237, 00003, 00008 Accuphase 00003 Acorn 00237 Action 00237 Active 00237 ADB 01230 Aichi Denshi 01512 Americast 00899 Amstrad 01222 Archer 00237 Auna 01230 Austar 00276
B
BCC 00276 Bell South 00899 Bestlink 00303 Birmingham Cable
Communications
00276
British Telecom 00003
C
Cable & Wireless 01068 Century 00008 Coship 01462
D
Daehan 00778 Daeryung 01877, 00877, 00477, 00008 Digeo 01187 Director 00476 DX Antenna 01500
E
Emerson 00303 Encon 00008
F
Fosgate 00276 Foxtel 01222 France Telecom 00817 Freebox 01482 Fujitsu 01497
G
Galaxi 00008 GE 00237, 00144
Gehua 00476 General Instrument 00476, 00810, 00276, 00003 Gibralter 00003 GNI 01466 GoldStar 00144
H
Hitachi 00003, 00008 Hongtian Jiangsu 01462 Hwalin 00303
I
Insight 00476, 00810
J
Jerrold 00476, 00810, 00276, 00003 Jiuzhou 01445
K
KNC 00008
L
LG 00144
M
Macab 00817 Madritel 01230 Maspro 01510 Matav 01082 Memorex 00000 Mitsubishi 00003
Motorola
01376, 00476, 00810, 00276, 01187
MS 00303
N
NEC 01496 Noos 00817 Nova Vision 00008 Novaplex 00008 NTL 00276, 00003, 01060, 01068
O
Oak 00303 Ono 01068 Optus 00276, 01060
P
Pace
01877, 00877, 00237, 00008, 01060, 01068, 01577
Panasonic 00000, 00008, 00144, 01488 Paragon 00000, 00008, 00525 Penney 00000 Philips 01305, 00317, 00817
Pioneer
01877, 00877, 00144, 00533,
01500 Pulsar 00000 PVP Stereo Visual
Matrix
00003
Q
Quasar 00000
R
RadioShack 00303 Regal 00276 Runco 00000
S
Sagem 00817 Salora 00000
Samsung
00003, 00000, 00144, 00778,
00840, 01060, 01666
Scientific Atlanta
01877, 00877, 00477, 00237,
00003, 00000, 00008, 01510 Skyworth 01464
Sony 01006, 01460
Sprucer 00144 Starcom 00003 StarHub 00276 Sumitomo 01500, 01504 Supercable 00276
T
Taihan 00778 TCL 01445 Telewest 01068 Time Warner cable 01877 TongKook 00840 Torx 00003 Toshiba 00000, 01509 Trans PX 00276, 00303 TS 00003, 00303
U
United Cable 00276, 00003 US Electronics 00276, 00003, 00008
V
Videoway 00000 Visiopass 00817
Z
Zenith 00000, 00525, 00899
Cable/PVR Combination b1
A
Americast 00899
D
Digeo 01187
F
Freebox 01482
G
General Instrument 00810
J
Jerrold 00810
M
Motorola 01376, 00810, 01187
P
Pace 01877, 00237 Pioneer 01877, 00877
S
Scientific Atlanta 01877, 00877 Sony 01006 Supercable 00276
T
Time Warner cable 01877
Z
Zenith 00899
CD Player
A
Acoustic Research 40420 Advantage 40032 Aiwa 40157 Arcam 40157 Audio Research 40157 Audiolab 40157 Audiomeca 40157 Audioton 40157 AVI 40157
B
Balanced Audio Technology
40157
Burmester 40420 Bush 40388
C
Cairn 40157 California Audio Labs
40029, 40303 Cambridge 40157 Cambridge Audio 40157
Cambridge Soundworks
40157
Carver 40157, 40179 CDC 40420 CEC 40420 Copland 40393 Curtis Mathes 40032 Cyrus 40157
D
Denon
40873, 40003, 40766,
[42867]z, 42868
DKK 40000 DMX Electronics 40157 Dual 40003 Dynaco 40157 Dynamic Bass 40179
F
Fisher 40000, 40179
G
Garrard 40393, 40420 Genexxa 40000, 40032, 40037, 40179 Goldmund 40157 Grundig 40157
H
Hafler 40173 Harman/Kardon 40100, 40157, 40173 Hitachi 40032
I
Inkel 40157 Integra 40101
J
Jerrold 40003 JVC 40032, 40072
K
Kenwood
40681, 40000, 40029, 40157,
40028, 40037, 40036, 40190 KLH 41318
Krell 40157
L
Linn 40157 Loewe 40157 Luxman 40393 LXI 40179
M
Magnavox 40157 Marantz 40029, 40157 Matsui 40157 MCS 40029
Memorex
40000, 40032, 40179, 40420,
40468 Meridian 40157
Micromega 40157 Miro 40000 Mission 40157
Modulaire
40000, 40032, 40087, 40179,
40420, 40468 MTC 40420
Musical Fidelity 40393 Myryad 40157
N
NAD 40000, 40721 Naim 40157 NSM 40157
O
Onkyo 40868, 40101
Optimus
40000, 40032, 40037, 40087, 40179, 40393, 40420, 40468
Orion 40393
P
Panasonic 40029, 40303, 40388, 40752 Parasound 40420 Penney 40029 Philips 40157 Pioneer 40032, 40101, 40468 Polk Audio 40157 Proceed 40420 Proton 40157
Q
QED 40157 Quad 40157 Quasar 40029
R
Radiola 40157
RadioShack
40000, 40032, 40179, 40420, 40468
RCA
40032, 40053, 40179, 40420, 40468
Realistic
40000, 40032, 40087, 40179, 40420, 40468
Restek 40157 Revox 40157 Roksan 40420 Rotel 40157, 40420 Royal 40420
S
SAE 40157 Saisho 40000 Sansui 40000, 40157 Sanyo 40000, 40087, 40179 SAST 40157 Sears 40179 Sharp 40037 Siemens 40157 Silsonic 40036 Simaudio 40157 Sonic Frontiers 40157
Sony
40490, 40000, 40100, 41364, 40185
Sugden 40157 Sylvania 40157
T
TAG McLaren 40157 Tandy 40032 Tascam 40393, 40420 Teac 40490, 40393, 40420 Technics 40029, 40303 Techwood 40303
List of preset codes / Liste de codes préréglés
PRESET CODE
Page 78
Thomson 40053 Thorens 40157 Thule Audio 40157 Tokai 40420
U
Universum 40157, 40053
V
Victor 40072
W
Wadia 40393
Wards
40000, 40032, 40157, 40053, 40087, 40179
Y
Yamaha 40490, 40868, 40032, 40036 Yorx 40000
CD Recorder
D
Denon 40766, 42868
J
JVC 40072
R
RCA 40053, 40420
S
Sony 40000, 40100, 41364
T
Teac 40420 Thomson 40053
Tape Deck
A
Aiwa 20029, 20197, 20200, 21315 Akai 20283, 20439 Arcam 20076 Audiolab 20029
C
Carver 20029
D
Denon
20076, 20371, 21311,
[22471]
z
F
Fisher 20074
G
Garrard 20308, 20309, 20375, 20439 Genexxa 20439 GoldStar 20375 Grundig 20029, 20375
H
Harman/Kardon 20182, 20029, 21314
I
Inkel 20070, 20071, 20337
J
JVC
20244, 20273, 20274, 20303, 20304, 20310, 21309
K
Kenwood
20070, 20071, 20092, 20233, 20234, 21364
L
LG 20375 Luxman 20308, 20309
M
Magnavox 20029 Marantz 20029, 20009 Memorex 20099 Mitsubishi 20283, 20439 Myryad 20029
O
Onkyo 20135, 20136, 20282 Optimus 20027, 20220, 20337, 20439 Orion 20308, 20309
P
Palladium 20375 Panasonic 20229 Philips 20029, 20229
Phonotrend 20337
Pioneer
20027, 20220, 20099, 20109, 21306, 21312
Polk Audio 20029
R
Radiola 20029 RCA 20027, 20220 Revox 20029
S
Sansui 20029, 20009 Sanyo 20074 Sharp 20231, 20371 Sherwood 20337 Sonic 20375
Sony
20243, 20170, 20291, 20234, 21313
T
TaeKwang 20439 Tandberg 20109
Teac
20280, 20283, 20289, 20308, 20309
Technics 20229 Technovox 20229 Thorens 20029
U
Universum 20375, 20439
V
Victor 20244, 20273, 20274
W
Wards 20027, 20029 Wharfedale 20439
Y
Yamaha 20097, 20094
HDTV Tuner b1
A
ABS 01272 Accurian 01653 Alienware 01272
C
CyberPower 01272
D
D-Link 01554 Dgtec 01363
E
Epson 01563
G
Gateway 01272
H
Hewlett Packard 01272, 01267 Howard Computers 01272 HP 01272, 01267 Hush 01272
I
iBUYPOWER 01272
L
LG 01415 Linksys 01272, 01365
M
Media Center PC 01272 Microsoft 01272, 01805 Mind 01272 Motorola 01363
N
Niveus Media 01272 Northgate 01272
P
Packard Bell 01272 Panasonic 01120 Pioneer 01010
R
Ricavision 01272
S
Samsung 01190, 01490 Sensory Science 01126 Sharp 01010 SMC 01456 Sony 01272, 01324, 01364 Stack 9 01272 Sylvania 01563 Systemax 01272
T
Tagar Systems 01272 Toshiba 01272 Touch 01272
V
Viewsonic 01272, 01329 Vizio 01126 Voodoo 01272
X
Xbox 01805
Z
ZT Group 01272
Satellite Receiver
A
@sat 01300 @Sky 01334 A-Mark 00345 ABsat 00123, 00713
ADB
00642, 01259, 01367, 01418, 01473, 01491
AGS 00710 Aiwa 01514 Akai 00200
Alba
00455, 00713, 01284, 01659, 01811
Allsat 00200, 01043 Alltech 00713 Allvision 01232, 01334, 01412 AlphaStar 00772 Amitronica 00713
Amstrad
00345, 00713, 00795, 00847, 00863, 00882, 01113, 01175, 01693, 01801
Anglo 00713 Ankaro 00713 AntSat 01083 Apollo 00455 Arcon 01043, 01075 Armstrong 00200 Arnion 01300 Asat 00200 ASCI 01334 ASLF 00713 AssCom 00853 Astacom 00710 Aston 00142 Astra 00713 Astratec 01743
Astro
00173, 00658, 01099, 01100,
01113 Atlantic Telephone 01333
Atsat 01300 AtSky 01334 Audioline 01672 Aurora 00642, 00879, 01333, 01433
Austar
00497, 00642, 00863, 00879,
01176, 01259 Axiel 00710
Axil 01457, 01659 Axis 01111
B
B@ytronic 01412 Beko 00455 Bell ExpressVu 00775 Big Sat 01457 Black Diamond 01284 Blaupunkt 00173 Blue Sky 00713 Boca 00713, 01232, 01366 Boston 00710, 01251 Brainwave 00658, 01672
British Sky Broadcasting
00847, 01175, 01662, 01847
Broco 00713 BskyB 00847, 01175, 01662 BT 00710, 01296 Bubu Sat 00713
Bush
01284, 01645, 01672, 01743,
01811
C
Canal 00853 Canal Digital 00853, 01622 Canal Satellite 00853, 01339, 01853 Canal+ 00853 Centrex 01457 CGV 01413, 01567 Chaparral 00216 Cherokee 00123, 00710 Chess 00713, 01085, 01334, 01626 Chili 01718
CityCom
00299, 00394, 00818, 01075,
01176, 01232 Classic 01672
Clatronic 01413 CNS 01367 Comag 01232, 01366, 01412, 01413 Condor 01700 Conia 01695 Contec 00394 Continental Edison 01695 Coship 01457 Crossdigital 01109 Crown 01284 Cryptovision 00455, 00795
Cyfra+ 01076 Cyrus 00200
D
D-box 00723, 00873, 01114 Daewoo 00713, 01111, 01296, 01743 Delfa 00863 Deltasat 01075 Dgtec 01542, 01631, 01242 Digenius 00299 Digiality 01685 Digifusion 01645, 01743 DigiLogic 01284 DigiQuest 00863, 01300, 01457, 01473 DigiSat 01232 Digisky 01457 DigitAll World 01227 Digiturk 01076 Digiwave 01631 Dijam 01296 DiPro 01367, 01543
DirecTV
01377, 00392, 00566, 00639, 01639, 01142, 00247, 00749, 01749, 00724, 00819, 01856, 01076, 01108, 00099, 01109, 01414, 01442, 01609, 01392, 01640
Discovery 00710 Dish Network System
01505, 01005, 00775, 01775 Dishpro 01505, 01005, 00775, 01775 Distratel 01283, 01704 DMT 01075 DNT 00200 Dream Multimedia 01237 DSE 01375 DSTV 00642, 00879, 01433 Durabrand 01284 DX Antenna 01530
E
Echostar
01505, 01005, 00775, 00455,
00610, 00713, 00853, 00871,
01086, 01200, 01323, 01409,
01418, 01473, 01775 Einhell 00713
Elap 00713, 01567 Elsat 00713 Elta 00200, 01659 Emme Esse 00871 Energy Sistem 01631 Engel 00713, 01251 EP Sat 00455 Esat 00879 Eurieult 00882
PRESET CODE
Page 79
Eurocrypt 00455 EuroLine 01251 Europa 00863 Europhon 00299 Eurosky 00262, 00299 Eurostar 00818 Eutelsat 00713 Expressvu 00775, 01775
F
Fenner 00713 Ferguson 00455, 01291, 01743 Finlandia 00455 Finlux 00455 Flair Mate 00713 FMD 01251, 01413, 01457 Force 01101 Fortec Star 01083
Foxtel
00455, 00497, 00795, 00879, 01162, 01176, 01356
Fracapro Planet 00871 Fracarro 00125, 00871 France Telecom 00871 Freesat 00882 FTE 00863 FTEmaximal 00713, 00863
Fuba
00173, 00262, 00299, 00394, 01214, 01251, 01801
Fugionkyo 00125 Funai 01377
G
Galaxis
00853, 00863, 01101, 01111, 01557
Gardiner 00818 Garnet 01075 GbSAT 01214 GE 00392, 00566 Gecco 01412 General Instrument 00869 General Satellite 01176 GF Good Friends 01043 GF Star 01043
Globo
01251, 01334, 01412, 01429, 01626
GOD Digital 00200 GOI 00775, 01775 Gold Box 00853 Gold Vision 01631 Golden Interstar 01283 GoldStar 00394 Goodmans 00455, 01284, 01291 Gradiente 00887 Granada 00455
Grundig
00173, 00345, 00847, 00853, 00879, 01291
H
Handan 01622 Hanseatic 01099, 01100
Hauppauge 01672 HB 01214, 01801 HDT 01159 Hills 01232
Hirschmann
00125, 00173, 00299, 00710, 00882, 01085, 01111, 01232, 01412
Hisense 01535
Hitachi
00749, 00819, 00455, 01250, 01284, 01518, 01523, 01525
Homecast 01214, 01680, 01700 Hornet 01300 Houston 00775 HTS 00775, 01775
Hughes Network Systems
01142, 00749, 01749, 01442
Humax
00863, 01176, 01225, 01406, 01427, 01675, 01743, 01790, 01915
Huth 01075 Hyundai 01075, 01159
I
iCan 01367 ID Digital 01176 ILLUSION sat 01557, 01631 iLo 01535 Imperial 01334, 01429, 01672 Indovision 00887 Ingelen 00882 Innova 00099 Interstar 01214 InVideo 00871 ISkyB 00887 Italtel 00871 ITT Nokia 00455, 00723, 00873
J
Jadeworld 00642 Jaeger 01334 Jerrold 00869 Jiuzhou 01450 JOK 00710 JVC 00775, 01507, 01531, 01775
K
K-SAT 00713 Kamm 00713 Kaon 01300 KaTelco 01111
Kathrein
00123, 00173, 00200, 00249, 00394, 00442, 00480, 00504, 00658, 00713, 00818, 01221, 01416, 01561, 01567
Kennex 00125 Kenwood 00853 Klap 00710 Kocmoc TB 01333 Koscom 01043 Kosmos 00442, 01333 Kreiling 00249, 00658
Kreiselmeyer 00173 Kross 01695
L
L&S Electronic 01043, 01334 Labgear 01296 LaSAT 00173, 00299 Lava 01631 Legend 01718 Legrand 01718 Lemon 01334 Lenco 00713 Lenoxx 01611 LG 01075, 01414 Lifesat 00299, 00713, 01043 Lodos 01284 Logik 01284 Logix 01075 Lorenzen 00299 Luxor 00345, 00873
M
M Electronic 00818 M vision 01557 Magnavox 00724, 00722 Manata 00710, 00713 Manhattan 00455, 00710, 01083 Marantz 00200 Maspro 00173, 00713, 01530 Master’s 00394 Matsui 00173, 00710, 01284, 01743 Maximum 01075, 01334, 01685 McIntosh 00869 MDS 01225 Mediabox 00853 Mediacom 01206 MediaSa 00853
Medion
00299, 00713, 01043, 01075, 01232, 01334, 01412, 01626
Medison 00713 Mega 00200 Memorex 00724
Metronic
00713, 00818, 01283, 01334, 01375, 01704
Metz 00173 MiCO 01811 Micro 00713 Micro Elektronic 00713 Micro Technology 00713 Micromaxx 00299 Microstar 01075 Microtec 00713 Mitsubishi 00749, 00455 Morgan’s 00200, 00713, 01232, 01412 Motorola 00869, 00856, 01473 MTEC 01214 Muller 01695
Multibroadcast 00642, 00879
Multichoice
00642, 00879, 01333, 01433, 01559, 01560
Mx Onda 01659 Myryad 00200 Mysat 00713 MySky 01693, 01848, 01850
N
NEC 01519 NEOTION 01334 Netgem 01322 Netsat 00099, 00887 Neuf TV 01322 Neuhaus 00713 Neuling 01232 Neusat 00713 Nevir 01659 Next Level 00869 Nikko 00200, 00713, 00723 Noda Electronic 01704
Nokia
00455, 00723, 00751, 00853, 00873, 01023, 01223, 01723
Nordmende 00455, 01611
O
OctalTV 01505 Okano 00442 Omega 00887 Opentel 01232, 01412
Optex
00394, 00713, 01043, 01283, 01611
Optimus 00724 Optus 00879 Orbis 01232, 01334, 01412 Orbitech 01099, 01100 Origo 00497 OSAT 00345
P
P/Sat 01232
Pace
00200, 00329, 00455, 00497, 00795, 00847, 00853, 00887, 01175, 01323, 01356, 01423, 01693, 01717, 01848, 01850
Pacific 01284, 01375 Packard Bell 01111 Packsat 00710 Palcom 00299, 01409 Panarex 01159 Panasat 00615, 00879, 01333, 01433
Panasonic
00247, 00701, 00455, 00847, 01304, 01404, 01508, 01526, 01527
Panda 00173, 00455 Pansat 01159 Patriot 00710 Paysat 00724 peeKTon 01457
Philips
01142, 00749, 01749, 00775,
00724, 00819, 01076, 00722,
00099, 00710, 00455, 00818,
00200, 00847, 00853, 00173,
01114, 00133, 01442, 01543,
01672 Phonotrend 00863, 01200
Pilotime 01339 Pino 01334
Pioneer
01142, 00329, 00853, 01308,
01442 Planet 00871
Plasmatic 00442 PMB 00713, 01611 Polytron 00394 Portland 01296 Preisner 00262, 01101, 01113, 01366 Premier 00723, 00853, 00873, 01429 Prima 00795 Primacom 01111 Primestar 00869 Profile 00710 Promax 00455 Proscan 00392, 00566 Proton 01535
Q
QNS 01367, 01402, 01404 Quadral 00710 Quelle 00299
R
Radiola 00200 RadioShack 00566, 00775, 00869 Radix 00394, 00882, 01113, 01317
RCA
00392, 00566, 01142, 00775,
00855, 00143, 01291, 01392,
01442 Rebox 01214
Regal 01251 RFT 00200 Roadstar 00713, 00853 Rollmaster 01413 Rover 00713 Rownsonic 01567
S
SAB 01251 Saba 00710, 00820 Sabre 00455
Sagem
00820, 01114, 01253, 01307,
01690
Samsung
01377, 01142, 01276, 01108,
01109, 00853, 00863, 01206,
01442, 01458, 01570, 01609,
01700, 01916 Sat Control 01300
Sat Team 00713 SAT+ 01409 Satec 00713 Satelco 01232 Satplus 01100
PRESET CODE
Page 80
PRESET CODE
Satstation 01083 Schaub Lorenz 01214 Schneider 00710, 01206, 01251
Schwaiger
00394, 00504, 00863, 01075, 01083, 01111, 01317, 01334, 01412, 01457
SCS 00299 Sedea Electronique 00125, 01206, 01283, 01626 SEG 01075, 01087, 01251, 01626 Seleco 00871 Septimo 01375 Serd 01412 Serino 00610 Servimat 01611 ServiSat 00713, 01251 Sharp 01517 Siemens 00173, 01334, 01429 Silva 00299 Skantin 00713 SKR 00713
SKY
00856, 00099, 00847, 00887, 01014, 01175, 01662, 01693, 01847, 01848, 01850
SKY Italia 00853, 01693, 01847, 01848 Sky Television 01014 Sky XL 01251, 01412 Sky+ 01175
Skymaster
00713, 01075, 01085, 01200, 01334, 01409, 01567, 01611
Skymax 00200 Skyplus 01232, 01334, 01412 SkySat 00713 Skyvision 01334 SL 00299, 01672 SM Electronic 00713, 01200, 01409
Smart
00713, 00882, 01101, 01113, 01232, 01404, 01413
Sony
00639, 01639, 00455, 00847, 00853, 01524, 01558, 01640
Star 00887 Star Choice 00869 Star Trak 00772, 00869 Starland 00713 Starlite 00200 Stream 01847, 01848
Strong
00125, 00713, 00820, 00853, 00879, 01159, 01284, 01300, 01409, 01626
Sunkai 00123 Sunny 01300 Sunsat 00713 Sunstar 00642 Supernova 00887 SVA 01455 Systec 01334
T
Tantec 00455 Tarbs 01225 Tatung 00455 TBoston 01659 Teac 01225, 01227, 01251, 01322 Tecatel 01200
TechniSat
00262, 00455, 00863, 01099, 01100, 01195, 01197, 01322
Technomate 01283, 01610 Technosonic 01672 Technotrend 01429 Techwood 01284, 01626
Tele System Electronic
01251, 01409, 01611, 01801
Teleciel 01043 TeleClub 01367 Telefunken 00710 Teleka 00262, 00442
Telestar
01099, 01100, 01251, 01334, 01610, 01626
Telesystem 01801 Televes 00455, 01214, 01300, 01334 Televisa 00887 Telewire 01232 Tevion 00713, 01409, 01622, 01672
Thomson
00392, 00566, 00455, 00710, 00713, 00820, 00847, 00853, 01046, 01175, 01291, 01534, 01543, 01662
Thorn 00455 Tiny 01672 Tioko 00394 Tivo 01142, 01442 Tokai 00200 Tonna 00455, 00713, 01611 Topfield 01206, 01208, 01545, 01783
Toshiba
00749, 01749, 00790, 00819, 00455, 01285, 01501, 01516, 01530
TPS 00820, 01253, 01307
Triax
00200, 00713, 00853, 01113, 01227, 01251, 01291, 01296, 01626
Trio 01075 TT-micro 01429 Turnsat 00713 Twinner 00713, 01611
U
UEC 00879, 01162, 01333, 01356 UltimateTV 01392, 01640 Uniden 00724, 00722 Unisat 00200 United 01251
Universum
00173, 00299, 01087, 01099, 01251
US Digital 01535 USDTV 01535
V
Variosat 00173 Ventana 00200 Vestel 01251 VH Sat 00299 Viasat 01682 ViewSat 01232 Visionic 00125, 01283 VisionNet 01557
Visiosat
00142, 00710, 00713, 01413, 01457, 01718
Viva 00856 Vivid 01162 Voom 00869 VTech 00818
W
Wavelength 01232, 01413 Wewa 00455 Wharfedale 01284 Winbox 01801 Wintel 00299 Wisi 00173, 00299, 00455
Worldsat
00123, 00710, 01214, 01251, 01543
X
Xcom 00123 XMS 01075
Xsat
00123, 00713, 00847, 01214, 01323
Xtreme 01300
Y
Yakumo 01413 Yamada 01718 Yes 00887
Z
Zehnder
00394, 00504, 00818, 01075, 01232, 01251, 01334, 01412, 01413
Zenith 00856, 01856 Zeta Technology 00200 Zodiac 01801
Satellite Receiver/ PVR Combination b1, b3
b1
A
@sat 01300 Allvision 01412 Amstrad 01175 Atsat 01300
B
B@ytronic 01412 British Sky
Broadcasting
01175
BskyB 01175, 01662 Bush 01645
C
Canal Satellite 01339 Comag 01412
D
Digifusion 01645 DigiQuest 01300 Digiturk 01076
DirecTV
01377, 00392, 00639, 01142, 01076, 00099, 01392, 01442, 01640
Dish Network System
01505, 00775 Dishpro 01505, 00775 DMT 01075 Dream Multimedia 01237
E
Echostar 01505, 00775, 00610 Expressvu 00775
F
Foxtel 01356
G
GbSAT 01214 Gecco 01412 Globo 01412
H
HDT 01159 Hirschmann 01412 Homecast 01680
Hughes Network Systems
01142, 01442
Humax 01176, 01427, 01675 Huth 01075 Hyundai 01075, 01159
K
Kaon 01300 Kathrein 00249, 00658, 01221, 01561
L
LG 01075
M
Maximum 01334 Mediacom 01206 Medion 01412 Microstar 01075 Morgan’s 01412 Motorola 00869 MTEC 01214 Multichoice 01333, 01559, 01560 MySky 01693, 01848, 01850
N
NEOTION 01334 Nokia 01023
O
Opentel 01412 Orbis 01412
P
Pace 01175, 01356, 01423, 01850 Panasonic 01304 Philips 01142, 00099, 01442 Pilotime 01339 Proscan 00392
R
Radix 01317 RCA 01392 Rebox 01214
S
Sagem 01253, 01307 Samsung 01206, 01442, 01570, 01609 Sat Control 01300 Schneider 01206 Schwaiger 01075, 01412 Sedea Electronique 01206 Serd 01412 SKY 01175, 01693, 01848, 01850
SKY Italia 01848 Sky XL 01412 Skymaster 01075 Skyplus 01412 Sony 00639, 01640 Star Choice 00869 Strong 01300 Sunny 01300
T
TechniSat 01195, 01197 Thomson 01175, 01534, 01662 Topfield 01206, 01545, 01783 TPS 01253, 01307
X
Xtreme 01300
Z
Zehnder 01075, 01412
b3
H
Hughes Network Systems
20739
P
Philips 20739
S
Samsung 20739
Television
1
888 10264
A
A-Mark 10047, 10054, 10009
A.R. Systems
10037, 10352, 10374, 10455, 10556
Accent 10009, 10037 Accuscan 10047 Accuscreen 10001 Acoustic Research 11269 Action 10030, 10650 Acura 10009 Addison 10092, 10108, 10653 ADL 11217
Admiral
10047, 10054, 10017, 10051, 10093, 10463, 10180, 10163, 10264, 10418
Advent
10761, 10783, 10815, 10817, 10842, 10876, 11933
Adventuri 10000 Adyson 10217 AEG 11163, 11556 Agashi 10217, 10264 Agna 10150
Aiko
10092, 10009, 10035, 10037, 10217, 10264, 10361, 10371, 10433
Aim 10706, 10037, 10455, 10805 Aiwa 10264, 10701, 11904, 11911
Akai
10000, 10060, 10812, 10702, 10178, 10030, 10145, 10602, 10606, 10631, 10648, 10672, 10714, 10715, 11207, 11537, 11675, 11676, 11903, 10556, 10548, 10480, 10433, 10371, 10361, 10264, 10218, 10217, 10208, 10163, 10037, 10035, 10009
Page 81
PRESET CODE
Akashi 10009, 10860 Akiba 10037, 10218, 10455 Akira 10418 Akito 10037
Akura
10171, 10009, 10037, 10163, 10218, 10264, 10668, 10714, 11037, 11498, 11556, 11982
Alaron 10170
Alba
10009, 10036, 10037, 10073, 10163, 10218, 10352, 10370, 10371, 10418, 10443, 10487, 10668, 10714, 11037
Albatron 10700, 10843 Alfide 10672 All-Tel 10865, 11269 Alleron 10030, 10170 Allorgan 10217 Allstar 10037 Ambassador 10150 America Action 10180 American High 10000, 10060 Amplivision 10217, 10370
Amstrad
10000, 10171, 10009, 10011, 10037, 10163, 10218, 10264, 10362, 10371, 10433, 10648, 11037, 11982
Amtron 10000, 10180
Anam
10250, 10180, 10009, 10037, 10700, 10861
Anam National 10250, 10037, 10650 Andersson 11149, 11163 Anglo 10009, 10264 Anhua 10051 Anitech 10009, 10037, 10264
Ansonic
10009, 10037, 10163, 10370, 10374, 10668
AOC
10451, 10093, 10180, 10060, 10178, 10030, 10092, 10009, 10108
Aolinpike 10264
Apex Digital
10156, 10748, 10879, 10765, 10767, 11217, 11943
AR 10352, 10556 Arc En Ciel 10109 Arcam 10217 Ardem 10037, 10714 Aristocrat 10163 Aristona 10037, 10556 ART 11037 Arthur Martin 10163 ASA 10070 Asberg 10037 Asora 10009 Astra 10037 Asuka 10217, 10218, 10264 ATD 10698 Atlantic 10001, 10037
Atori 10009 Auchan 10163 Audinac 10180
Audiosonic
10009, 10037, 10109, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10370, 10374, 10486, 10714, 10715, 10820
Audioton 10217, 10264, 10370, 10486
Audiovox
10451, 10180, 10092, 10623, 10802, 10875, 11937, 11951, 11952
Audioworld 10698 Aumark 10060 Autovox 10217 Aventura 10171 AVP 10000
Awa
10451, 10009, 10011, 10036, 10108, 10217, 10264, 10374, 10606
Axion 11937, 11958 Axxent 10009
B
Baier 10876 Baihe 10009, 10264 Baile 10001, 10009, 10374, 10661
Baird
10037, 10073, 10109, 10208, 10217, 10343, 11196
Bang & Olufsen 10565 Baohuashi 10264 Baosheng 10009, 10817 Barco 10163, 10556
Basic Line
10009, 10037, 10163, 10217, 10218, 10374, 10455, 10556, 10668, 11037, 11163
Bastide 10217 Bauer 10805
Baur
10037, 10195, 10361, 10455, 10512
Baysonic 10180 Bazin 10217 Beaumark 10017, 10178, 10030
Beijing
10812, 10001, 10009, 10208, 10226, 10264, 10374, 10661, 10817, 10821
Beko
10037, 10195, 10370, 10418, 10486, 10606, 10714, 10715, 10808, 11037
Belcor 10030 Bell & Howell 10054, 10017, 10154, 10093 Belson 10698, 11191 Belstar 11037 BenQ 11032, 11756 Beon 10037, 10163, 10218, 10418 Berthen 10668 Best 10370 Bestar 10037, 10370, 10374 Bestar-Daewoo 10374 Binatone 10217
Black Diamond
10614, 10820, 10821, 11037, 11163, 11909
Blackway 10218
Blaupunkt
10036, 10170, 10195, 10200, 10327, 10455
Blue Sky
10037, 10218, 10455, 10487, 10499, 10556, 10668, 10714, 10715, 11037, 11191, 11363
Boots 10009, 10217 BPL 10037, 10208 Bradford 10180
Brandt
10109, 10287, 10335, 10560, 10625, 10714
Brinkmann 10037, 10418, 10486, 10668 Brionvega 10037, 10362 Britannia 10217 Brockwood 10178, 10030
Broksonic
10236, 10463, 10180, 11911, 11938
Brother 10264 BSR 10163 BTC 10218
Bush
11900, 11556, 11037, 10778, 10714, 10698, 10668, 10661, 10614, 10556, 10487, 10374, 10371, 10361, 10335, 10264, 10218, 10217, 10208, 10163, 10037, 10036, 10009
C
Caihong 10009, 10817 Cailing 10748 Candle 10030 Canton 10218
Capehart
10017, 10178, 10030, 10092, 10036
Capetronic 10030 Capsonic 10264 Carad 10610, 10668, 11037 Carena 10037, 10455 Carnivale 10030 Carrefour 10036, 10037, 10070 Carver 10054, 10170 Cascade 10009, 10037 Casio 10037 Cathay 10037, 10218 CCE 10037, 10217 Celebrity 10000 Celera 10765 Celestial 10767, 10819, 10820, 10821 Centrex 10780 Centrum 11037 Centurion 10037 CGE 10074, 10163, 10370, 10418
Changcheng
10051, 10001, 10009, 10264, 10374, 10661, 10817
Changfei 10009, 10374, 10817 Changfeng 10264, 10817 Changhai 10009, 10817
Changhong
10156, 10765, 10009, 10264,
10508, 10767, 10783, 10817,
10819, 10820, 10821, 11008,
11156 Chengdu 10009, 10817
Ching Tai 10092, 10009
Chun Yun
10000, 10180, 10092, 10009,
10700, 10843 Chunfeng 10009, 10264
Chung Hsin 10180, 10053, 10036, 10108 Chunsun 10009, 10817 Cimline 10009, 10218 Cinema 10672 Cineral 10451, 10092 Cinex 10648, 11556 Citek 10047
Citizen
10054, 10000, 10451, 10463,
10180, 10060, 10030, 10171,
10092, 10001, 10035 City 10009
Clarion 10180 Clarivox 10037, 10070, 10418 Classic 10030, 10092, 10499
Clatronic
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10264, 10370, 10371, 10714 Clayton 11037
CMS Hightec 10217
Colortyme
10047, 10054, 10017, 10060,
10178, 10030 Commercial Solutions
11447, 10047 Concorde 10009
Condor
10009, 10037, 10264, 10370,
10418 Conia 10820, 10821, 11498
Conic 10178 Conrac 10808
Conrowa
10156, 10145, 10009, 10264,
10698, 11156, 11170 Contec 10180, 10009, 10036, 10037
Continental Edison 10109, 10287, 10487 Cosmel 10009, 10037 Craig 10180, 10171
Crosley
10054, 10000, 10180, 10030,
10171, 10074, 10163, 10370
Crown
10093, 10180, 10053, 10009,
10037, 10208, 10370, 10418,
10486, 10487, 10606, 10672,
10712, 10714, 10715, 11037 Crown Mustang 10672
CS Electronics 10218 CTX 11756
Curtis Mathes
10047, 10054, 10154, 10000,
10051, 10451, 10093, 10180,
10060, 10702, 10178, 10030,
10145, 10166, 10037, 10035,
11147, 11347 CXC 10180
Cybertron 10218 Cytronix 11298
D
D-Vision 10037, 10556, 11982
Daewoo
10154, 10451, 10180, 10178, 10030, 10092, 11661, 10634, 10661, 10672, 10700, 10860, 10865, 10876, 10880, 11755, 11756, 11909, 10623, 10556, 10499, 10374, 10264, 10218, 10217, 10170, 10109, 10108, 10037, 10036, 10009
Dainichi 10218
Dansai
10009, 10035, 10036, 10037, 10208, 10217
Dantax 10370, 10486, 10714, 10715 Datsura 10208 Dawa 10009, 10037 Daytek 10672, 11207 Dayton 10092, 10009, 11207
Daytron
10180, 10178, 10030, 10092, 10009, 10036, 10037, 10374
Dayu 10374, 10661 De Graaf 10163, 10208, 10548 Decca 10037, 10217 Degraff 10163, 10208 Deitron 10374 Dell 11080, 11178 Denko 10264 Denon 10145, 10511 Denver 10037, 10587 Desmet 10009, 10037 Diamant 10037
Diamond
10706, 10009, 10371, 10672, 10698, 10820, 10860
Digatron 10037 Digiline 10037, 10668 Digital Life 10872 Digitex 10820 Digitor 10037 Digix Media 10880 Dixi 10009, 10037, 10217 DL 10587, 10780, 10872 Domeos 10668 Domland 10394 Dongda 10009 Donghai 10009 Dream Vision 11164, 11704 DSE 10698, 10820, 11556 DTS 10009
Dual
10037, 10217, 10343, 10352, 10394, 11037, 11137
Dual Tec 10217
Dumont
10017, 10180, 10178, 10070, 10217
Durabrand
10463, 10180, 10178, 10171, 11034, 11463
Dux 10037 Dwin 10093 Dynatech 10217 Dynatron 10037
Page 82
PRESET CODE
E
Easy Living 11248 Eaton 10060 Ecco 10773 ECE 10037 Edison-Minerva 10487
Elbe
10037, 10217, 10218, 10362, 10610
Elcit 10163 Electroband 10000 Electrograph 11755
Electrohome
10154, 10000, 10463, 10150, 10178, 10030, 10073
Elekta 10009, 10264 Elfunk 11037, 11208 ELG 10037 Elin 10009, 10037, 10361, 10548 Elite 10037, 10218 Elta 10009, 10264 Emerald 10178
Emerson
10047, 10017, 10154, 10451, 10236, 10463, 10180, 10150, 10178, 10171, 11944, 11911, 11909, 10714, 10668, 10623, 10486, 10036, 10371, 10370, 10361, 10037, 10195, 10170, 10070, 10073
Envision 10030, 10813 Enzer 10860 Erae 11371 Erres 10037 ESA 10812, 10171, 11944 ESC 10037, 10217 Ether 10030, 10009 Etron 10001, 10009, 10163, 10820 Eurofeel 10217, 10264 Euroman 10037, 10217, 10264, 10370 Europa 10037 Europhon 10037, 10109, 10217 Evesham Technology 11248 Evolution 11756 Expert 10163 Exquisit 10037
F
Feilang 10009 Feilu 10009, 10817 Feiyan 10264 Feiyue 10009, 10817 Fenner 10009, 10374 Fer0 10335
Ferguson
10053, 10037, 10073, 10109, 10195, 10287, 10335, 10343, 10443, 10548, 10560, 10625, 11037
Fidelity
10171, 10037, 10163, 10217, 10264, 10361, 10371, 10512
Filsai 10217
Finlandia
10163, 10208, 10346, 10361, 10548
Finlux
10037, 10070, 10163, 10217, 10346, 10480, 10556, 10631, 10714, 10715, 10808, 11556
Firstar 10236, 10009
Firstline
10009, 10037, 10208, 10217, 10361, 10374, 10556, 10668, 10714, 10808, 11037, 11191, 11363, 11371
Fisher
10047, 10054, 10154, 10000, 10036, 10208, 10217, 10361, 10370
Flint
10037, 10218, 10264, 10455, 10610
Force 11149 Formenti 10037, 10163 Fortress 10093 Fraba 10037, 10370
Friac
10009, 10037, 10370, 10499, 10610
Frontech 10009, 10163, 10217, 10264 Fujimaro 10865, 11498
Fujitsu
10009, 10217, 10352, 10683, 10809, 10853
Fujitsu General 10009, 10217, 10683 Fujitsu Siemens 10808, 10809, 11163, 11298
Funai
10000, 10180, 10171, 10264, 10668, 11271, 11904
Furi 10145, 10264, 10817 Furichi 10860 Futronic 10264, 10860 Futuretech 10180
G
Galaxi 10037 Galaxis 10037, 10370 Ganxin 10817 Gateway 11755, 11756 GBC 10009, 10163, 10218, 10374
GE
11447, 10047, 11454, 10000, 10051, 10451, 10093, 10180, 10060, 10178, 10030, 10092, 11922, 11917, 11347, 11147, 10625, 10560, 10335, 10035
GEC 10037, 10163, 10217, 10361 Geloso 10009, 10163, 10374 Gemini 10047 General 10109, 10287 General Technic 10009 Genesis 10009, 10037 Genexxa 10009, 10037, 10163, 10218
Gericom
10808, 10865, 10880, 11217, 11298
Gevalt 11371 Giant 10009, 10217 Gibralter 10017, 10000, 10030 Go Video 10060, 10886 Go Vision 11937 Goldfunk 10668
GoldStar
10047, 10054, 10154, 10178, 10030, 10715, 10714, 10606, 10455, 10361, 10217, 10163, 10109, 10073, 10037, 10036, 10009, 10001
Gooding 10487
Goodmans
10000, 11909, 11900, 11163, 11037, 10880, 10808, 10714, 10668, 10661, 10634, 10625, 10587, 10560, 10556, 10499, 10487, 10480, 10374, 10371, 10343, 10335, 10264, 10218, 10217, 10037, 10036, 10035, 10011, 10009
Gorenje 10370 GPM 10218 Gradiente 10053, 10037, 10170
Graetz
10163, 10361, 10371, 10487, 10714, 11163
Gran Prix 10648
Granada
10036, 10037, 10108, 10163, 10208, 10217, 10226, 10343, 10548, 10560
Grandin
10009, 10037, 10163, 10218, 10374, 10455, 10610, 10668, 10714, 10715, 10865, 10880, 11037, 11191
Gronic 10217
Grundig
10706, 10009, 10036, 10037, 10070, 10163, 10195, 10443, 10487, 10556, 10587, 10672, 10683, 11371
Grundy 10180, 10195 Grunkel 11163 Grunpy 10180
H
H & B 10808 Haaz 10706
Haier
11034, 10037, 10508, 10587, 10698, 11017
Haihong 10009 Haiyan 10264, 10817 Halifax 10217, 10264 Hallmark 10236, 10180, 10178 Hampton 10217 Hanimex 10218 Hankook 10180, 10178, 10030
Hanseatic
10009, 10037, 10217, 10361, 10370, 10394, 10499, 10556, 10634, 10661, 10714, 10808
Hantarex 10009, 10037, 10865 Hantor 10037
Harley Davidson
10000, 10180, 10060, 10178, 10030, 11904
Harman/Kardon 10054 Harsper 10865 Harvard 10180 Harwa 10773, 11196, 11269 Harwood 10009, 10037, 10487 Hauppauge 10037 Havermy 10093
HCM
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10418
Heathkit 10017 Helios 10865 Hello Kitty 10451
Hema 10009, 10217 Hewlett Packard 11494, 11502 Hifivox 10109 Highline 10037, 10264 Hikona 10218 Hikone 10218
Hinari
10009, 10036, 10037, 10163,
10208, 10218, 10264, 10352,
10443 Hisawa 10218, 10455, 10610, 10714
Hisense
10156, 10748, 10145, 10009,
10208, 10508, 10556, 10780,
10821, 10860, 11022, 11156,
11170, 11208, 11363
Hitachi
10047, 10054, 10017, 10000,
11256, 10156, 10051, 10150,
10178, 10030, 11145, 10145,
10092, 10744, 10877, 10634,
11037, 11137, 11149, 11156,
11170, 11225, 11576, 11904,
11960, 10578, 10548, 10508,
10499, 10481, 10480, 10343,
10217, 10163, 10109, 10108,
10037, 10036, 10035, 10009 Hitachi Fujian 10150, 10108, 10860
Hitec 10698 Hitsu 10009, 10218, 10455, 10610 Hoeher 10714, 10865, 11163, 11556 Home Electronics 10606 Hongmei 10093, 10009, 10264, 10817 Hongyan 10264, 10817 Hornyphon 10037 Hoshai 10218, 10455 HP 11494, 11502 Hua Tun 10009 Huafa 10145, 10009 Huanghaimei 10009 Huanghe 10009, 10817 Huanglong 10009 Huangshan 10009, 10264, 10817 Huanyu 10217, 10264, 10374, 10817 Huaqiang 10264 Huari 10145, 10264 Hugoson 11217 Huodateji 10051 Hygashi 10217 Hyper 10009, 10217 Hypersonic 10361
Hypson
10037, 10217, 10264, 10455,
10486, 10556, 10668, 10714,
10715, 11037
Hyundai
10849, 10860, 10865, 10876,
11556
I
Iberia 10037
ICE
10037, 10217, 10218, 10264,
10371 ICeS 10218
Iiyama 10877, 11217
Ima 10236, 10180, 10178 Imperial 10037, 10074, 10370, 10418
Imperial Crown
10001, 10009, 10264, 10374, 10661
Indiana 10037 Infinity 10054 InFocus 11164 Ingelen 10163, 10487, 10610, 10714 Ingersol 10009 Inno Hit 10009, 10217, 10218, 11163 Innova 10037 Innowert 10865, 11298 Inotech 10773, 10820 Insignia 10171, 11517 Inteq 10017, 10145 Interbuy 10009, 10037, 10264
Interfunk
10037, 10109, 10163, 10200, 10327, 10361, 10512
Internal 10037, 11909
Intervision
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10394, 10455, 10486, 10487
Irradio 10009, 10037, 10218, 10371 Isukai 10037, 10218, 10455 ITC 10217 ITS 10037, 10218, 10264, 10371
ITT
10163, 10208, 10346, 10361, 10480, 10548, 10610
ITT Nokia
10070, 10163, 10195, 10208, 10346, 10361, 10480, 10548, 10606, 10610
ITV 10037, 10264, 10374 IX 10877
J
JBL 10054 JCB 10000 JDV 11982
Jean
10156, 10051, 10236, 10092, 10009, 10036
JEC 10035 Jensen 10761, 10815, 10817, 11933 Jiahua 10051 JiaLiCai 10009, 10264 JIL 10030 Jinfeng 10051, 10208, 10226, 10817 Jinque 10009, 10264, 10817 Jinta 10009, 10264
Jinxing
10054, 10156, 10145, 10009, 10037, 10264, 10556, 10698, 10817, 10821, 11011
JMB 10443, 10499, 10556, 10634 JNC 10876 Jocel 10712 Johnson 10455 Jubilee 10556 Juhua 10264, 10817 Jutan 10030
Page 83
PRESET CODE
JVC
10054, 10093, 10463, 10053, 10030, 10070, 10036, 10218, 10371, 10418, 10508, 10606, 10650, 10653, 10683, 10731, 11253, 11923
K
Kaige 10009, 10264, 10817
Kaisui
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10455
Kambrook 10217 Kamp 10017, 10180, 10217
Kangli
10001, 10009, 10264, 10374, 10661, 10817
Kangyi 10009, 10264 Kapsch 10163, 10361
Karcher
10264, 10370, 10606, 10610, 10714, 10778, 11556
Kathrein 10556 Kawa 10371 Kawasho 10030 KB Aristocrat 10163 KDS 11498 KEC 10180, 10060
Kendo
10037, 10362, 10370, 10610, 10648, 11037
Kennedy 10163 Kennex 10668, 11037 Kenwood 10180, 10030 Khind 10706 KIC 10217 Kiota 10001, 10371, 10455 Kioto 10706, 10556 Kiton 10037, 10668
KLH
10156, 10180, 10765, 10767, 11962
KLL 10037 Kloss 10030
Kneissel
10037, 10362, 10370, 10374, 10499, 10556, 10610
Kolin
10180, 10150, 10053, 10036, 10108, 11331
Kolster 10037, 10218 Kongque 10009, 10264, 10817 Konichi 10009 Konig 10037
Konka
10180, 10037, 10218, 10371, 10418, 10587, 10641, 10714, 10817, 11084
Kontakt 10487 Korpel 10037 Korting 10370 Kosmos 10037 Koyoda 10009 Kreisen 10876 KTV 10463, 10180, 10030, 10217 Kuaile 10009, 10264 Kulun 10009
Kunlun
10051, 10208, 10226, 10264, 10374, 10661, 10817
Kyoshu 10418 Kyoto 10163, 10217
L
L&S Electronic 10714, 10808, 10865 Lark 10154 LaSAT 10486 Lavis 11037 Leader 10009 Lecson 10037 Legend 10009 Lenco 10037, 10374, 10587 Lenoir 10009 Lexsor 11196 Leyco 10037, 10264
LG
10054, 11265, 10060, 10178, 10030, 11758, 11637, 11191, 11178, 10856, 10715, 10714, 10700, 10698, 10556, 10370, 10361, 10217, 10163, 10109, 10108, 10037, 10009, 10001
Liesenk & Tter 10037 Liesenkotter 10037, 10327
Lifetec
10009, 10037, 10218, 10374, 10668, 10683, 10714, 11037, 11137
Lihua 10817
Lloyd’s
10236, 10180, 10030, 10001, 10009, 11904
Local India TV 10009, 10208, 10602 Local Malaysia TV 10698 Lodos 11037
Loewe
10037, 10370, 10512, 10633, 10790
Logik
10236, 10180, 10060, 10001, 10009, 10011, 10371, 10698, 10773, 10880, 11037, 11217
Logix 10668 Longjiang 10264, 10817 Luker 11982
Luma
10009, 10163, 10362, 10374, 11037
Lumatron
10037, 10073, 10163, 10217, 10264, 10361, 10556
Lux May 10009, 10037
Luxor
10163, 10208, 10217, 10346, 10361, 10480, 10548, 10631, 11037, 11163
LXI
10047, 10054, 10017, 10154, 10000, 10156, 10051, 10093, 10060, 10053, 10178, 10030, 10171, 10166, 10037, 10036, 10035, 10001, 10208
M
M Electronic
10009, 10037, 10109, 10163, 10195, 10217, 10287, 10343, 10346, 10374, 10480, 10512, 10634, 10661, 10714
Madison 10037 MAG 11498 Magnadyne 10054, 10163 Magnafon 10073
Magnasonic
10054, 10000, 10156, 10093, 10030, 10092, 10109
Magnavox
10047, 11454, 10054, 10154, 10000, 10250, 10051, 10180, 10060, 10030, 10171, 10092, 10706, 11944, 11904, 11755, 11254, 10802, 10780, 10011, 10035, 10037, 10036
Magnum 10037, 10648, 10714, 10715 Majestic 10017 Mandor 10264 Manesth 10035, 10037, 10217, 10264
Manhattan
10037, 10668, 10778, 10876, 11037, 11267
Marantz
11454, 10054, 10030, 10037, 10556, 10704, 10855
Mark
10009, 10037, 10217, 10374, 10714, 10715
Master’s 10499 Mastro 10053, 10706, 10698, 10780
Masuda
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10371
Matsui
11037, 10744, 10714, 10556, 10487, 10455, 10443, 10433, 10371, 10352, 10335, 10217, 10208, 10195, 10163, 10037, 10036, 10035, 10011, 10009
Matsushita 10250, 10051, 10650 Maxdorf 10773 Maxent 11755, 11756 Maxim 11556, 11982 MCE 10009 Meck 10698 Mediator 10037, 10556
Medion
10037, 10512, 10556, 10668, 10698, 10714, 10808, 10880, 11037, 11137, 11248, 11900
Megapower 10700 Megas 10610 Megatron 10047, 10178, 10145, 10009 MEI 11037 Meile 10264, 10817
Memorex
10154, 10250, 10463, 10180, 10150, 10060, 10178, 10030, 10009, 10035, 10037, 10195, 10877, 11037, 11911
Memphis 10009 Mercury 10060, 10001, 10009, 10037 Mermaid 10037 Metronic 10625
Metz
10037, 10195, 10367, 10388, 10447, 10587, 10668, 10746, 11163
MGA
10150, 10178, 10030, 10218, 10374
MGN Technology 10178 Micro Genius 10150
Micromaxx
10037, 10668, 10714, 10808, 11037
Microstar 10808 MicroTEK 10820, 10860 Midland 10047, 10017, 10051 Mikomi 11037, 11149
Minato 10037, 10556 Minerva 10070, 10108, 10195, 10487 Minoka 10037 Mirror 11900
Mitsubishi
10154, 10250, 10093, 10236,
10180, 11250, 10150, 10178,
10030, 11917, 11037, 10836,
10817, 10556, 10512, 10195,
10108, 10037, 10036, 10011 Mivar 10217
Monaco 10009 Monivision 10700, 10843 Morgan’s 10037 Motorola 10054, 10051, 10093, 10150
MTC
10180, 10060, 10030, 10092,
10011, 10370, 10512 MTlogic 10714
Mudan
10051, 10009, 10208, 10226,
10264, 10817
Multitec
10037, 10486, 10668, 11037,
11556
Multitech
10180, 10009, 10037, 10217,
10264, 10370, 10486 Murphy 10163
Musikland 10218 Mx Onda 11498 Myryad 10556
N
NAD
10156, 10178, 10166, 10037,
10361, 10866, 11156 Naiko 10037, 10606, 11982
Nakimura 10037, 10374 Nanbao 10009, 10264 Nansheng 10264, 10817 Narita 11982 NAT 10226 National 10051, 10208, 10226, 10508
NEC
10047, 10154, 10156, 10051,
10053, 10178, 10030, 11704,
11270, 11170, 10817, 10704,
10661, 10653, 10508, 10499,
10455, 10374, 10264, 10217,
10170, 10036, 10011, 10009
Neckermann
10037, 10200, 10327, 10370,
10418, 10556 NEI 10037, 10163, 10371
Neovia 10865, 10876, 11371 Netsat 10037 NetTV 11755
Neufunk
10009, 10037, 10218, 10556,
10610, 10714
New Tech
10009, 10037, 10217, 10343,
10556 New World 10218
Newave 10093, 10178, 10092, 10009
Nikkai
10009, 10035, 10036, 10037,
10163, 10217, 10218, 10264 Nikkei 10714
Nikko 10178, 10030, 10092 Nikkodo 10178, 10030, 10092
Nishi 10030 Nobliko 10070 Nogamatic 10109
Nokia
10163, 10208, 10346, 10361, 10374, 10480, 10548, 10606, 10610, 10631
Norcent 10748, 10824 Nordic 10217
Nordmende
10037, 10109, 10195, 10287, 10343, 10560, 10714
Normerel 10037 Novatronic 10037, 10374 NTC 10092 Nu-Tec 10455, 10698, 10820 Nyon 10000
O
Oceanic 10163, 10208, 10361, 10548 Odeon 10264 Okano 10009, 10037, 10264, 10370 Olevia 11144, 11240, 11331, 11610 Omega 10264 Omni 10748, 10698, 10780, 10872 Onida 10053, 11253 Onimax 10714
Onwa
10180, 10218, 10371, 10433, 10602
Opera 10037
Optimus
10154, 10250, 10093, 10180, 10150, 10178, 10030, 10166, 10650
Optoma 10887 Optonica 10093 Orbit 10037 Orcom 11504
Orion
10017, 10236, 10463, 10180, 10178, 11463, 10011, 10037, 10264, 10443, 10556, 10714, 10880, 11196, 11911
Orline 10037, 10218 Ormond 10668, 11037
Osaki
10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10374, 10556
Osio 10037 Oso 10218 Osume 10036, 10037, 10218 Otic 11498
Otto Versand
10093, 10036, 10037, 10109, 10195, 10217, 10226, 10343, 10361, 10512, 10556
P
Pace 10092
Pacific
10037, 10443, 10556, 10714, 11037, 11137
Palladium
10037, 10163, 10200, 10217, 10327, 10370, 10418, 10556, 10714, 11137
Palsonic
10001, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10418, 10698, 10773, 10778, 11196, 11269, 11904
Panama 10009, 10037, 10217, 10264 Panashiba 10001
Page 84
PRESET CODE
Panasonic
10054, 10000, 10156, 10250, 10051, 10236, 10030, 11947, 11946, 11941, 11480, 11310, 11291, 11271, 10853, 10650, 10548, 10508, 10367, 10361, 10226, 10208, 10163, 10108, 10037, 10035
Panavision 10037
Panda
10051, 10706, 10009, 10208, 10226, 10264, 10508, 10698, 10780, 10817, 10821
Pathe Cinema 10163 Pathe Marconi 10109 Pausa 10009 Paxonic 10060, 10030
PCE 10156, 10060
Penney
10047, 10000, 10156, 10250, 10051, 10060, 10178, 10030, 10035, 10036, 10037, 10070, 10108, 11347
Perdio 10037, 10163 Perfekt 10037 Petters 11523
Philco
10054, 10451, 10463, 10180, 10178, 10030, 10145, 11661, 10037, 10074, 10163, 10370, 10418
Philharmonic 10217
Philips
11454, 10054, 10017, 10000, 10051, 10178, 10030, 10171, 10092, 11961, 11756, 11254, 10690, 10556, 10512, 10374, 10361, 10343, 10200, 10108, 10037, 10009
Phocus 10714 Phoenix 10037, 10163, 10370, 10486 Phonola 10037, 10556
Pilot
10051, 10060, 10178, 10030, 10706, 10011
Pioneer
10166, 10011, 10037, 10109, 10163, 10170, 10287, 10361, 10370, 10486, 10512, 10679, 10760, 10866, 11260
Pionier 10370, 10486, 11556 Plantron 10009, 10037, 10264 Playsonic 10037, 10217, 10714, 10715
Polaroid
10765, 10865, 11276, 11316, 11341, 11498, 11523
Poppy 10009 Portland 10451, 10092, 10374 Powerpoint 10037, 10487, 10698 Prandoni-Prince 10361 Precision 10236, 10180, 10217 Premier 10009, 10264 President 10860
Prima
10761, 10009, 10264, 10783, 10815, 10817, 11269, 11933
Princeton 10700 Prinston 11037 Prinz 10361 Prism 10250, 10051
Profex 10009, 10163, 10361 Profi 10009 Profilo 11556 Profitronic 10037
Proline
10037, 10073, 10625, 10634, 11037
Proscan 11447, 10047, 11347, 11922 Prosco 10156
Prosonic
10037, 10217, 10370, 10371, 10374, 10668, 10714
Protec 10009, 10037, 10217, 10264
Protech
10009, 10037, 10217, 10264, 10418, 10486, 10668, 11037
Proton 10178, 10030, 10001, 10009
Proview 11498
ProVision 10037, 10556, 10714, 11037 Pulsar 10017, 10092 Pulser 10178, 10092 Pvision 10876, 11191 Pye 10037, 10374, 10556 Pymi 10009
Q
Qingdao
10051, 10208, 10226, 10264, 10817
Quadral 10051, 10218 Quartz 10150, 10178
Quasar
10250, 10051, 10009, 10035, 10650, 10865
Quelle
10011, 10037, 10070, 10074, 10109, 10195, 10200, 10327, 10361, 10512, 10668, 11037
Questa 10036 Questar 10036
R
R-Line 10037 Rabbit 10047 Radialva 10163, 10218 Radiola 10037, 10217, 10556 Radiomarelli 10037
RadioShack
10047, 10154, 10180, 10150, 10178, 10030, 10037, 11904
Radiotone
10009, 10037, 10264, 10370, 10418, 10648, 10668, 11037
Rank 10070 Rank Arena 10036, 10602 RBM 10070
RCA
11447, 10047, 11454, 10054, 10000, 10051, 10093, 10178, 10030, 10092, 11958, 11953, 11948, 11922, 11917, 11547, 11347, 11247, 11147, 11047, 10679, 10625, 10560, 10090
Realistic
10047, 10154, 10180, 10150, 10178, 10030
Recor 10037, 10418 Rectiligne 10037
Rediffusion
10036, 10163, 10346, 10361, 10548
Redstar 10037 Reflex 10037, 10668, 11037
Relisys
10865, 10876, 10877, 11207, 11298
Remotec
10250, 10093, 10145, 10171, 10037
Reoc 10714 Revox 10037 Rex 10163, 10264 RFT 10037, 10264 Rinex 10773
Roadstar
10009, 10037, 10218, 10264, 10418, 10668, 10714, 11037, 11900
Rolson 11371 Rover 10036, 10877
Rowa
10748, 10009, 10037, 10264, 10587, 10698, 10712, 10817
Royal Lux 10335, 10370 Runco 10017, 10060, 10030 Ruyi 10817
S
Saba
10250, 10109, 10163, 10287, 10335, 10343, 10361, 10498, 10548, 10560, 10625, 10714
Sagem 10455, 10610, 10618 Saige 10009, 10817
Saisho
10009, 10011, 10163, 10217, 10264
Saivod
10037, 10668, 10712, 11037, 11163, 11556, 11982
Sakai 10163 Sakyno 10455
Salora
10163, 10208, 10361, 10480, 10548, 10631
Salsa 10335
Sampo
10047, 10154, 10093, 10178, 10030, 10171, 10092, 10009, 10036, 10650, 10700, 11755, 11756
Samsung
10047, 10054, 10017, 10154, 10156, 10093, 10060, 10812, 10702, 10178, 10030, 10092, 10814, 10766, 10718, 10618, 10587, 10817, 10821, 11060, 11249, 11312, 11903, 11959, 10556, 10371, 10370, 10362, 10264, 10226, 10217, 10208, 10163, 10090, 10037, 10036, 10035, 10009
Sandra 10217 Sanjian 10264 Sanky 10060, 10030
Sansui
10463, 10060, 10030, 10706, 10037, 10371, 10455, 10602, 10714, 10861, 11371, 11537, 11904, 11911
Santon 10009
Sanyo
10047, 10054, 10154, 10000, 10156, 10463, 10180, 10145, 10171, 11755, 11208, 10704, 10508, 10370, 10264, 10217, 10208, 10170, 10163, 10108, 10088, 10037, 10036, 10011, 10009
Sanyong 10037 Sanyuan 10093, 10009, 10817 Saville 10060
SBR 10037, 10556 Sceptre 11217
Schaub Lorenz
10361, 10374, 10486, 10548,
10606, 10714, 11191
Schneider
11982, 11904, 11137, 11037,
10714, 10668, 10648, 10556,
10394, 10371, 10361, 10352,
10343, 10218, 10217, 10163,
10070, 10037 Scotch 10178
Scotland 10163 Scott 10236, 10180, 10178, 10030
Sears
10047, 10054, 10017, 10154,
10000, 10156, 10051, 10093,
10060, 10053, 10178, 10030,
10171, 10166, 10035, 10036,
10037, 10001, 10208, 11904 Seaway 10634
Seelver 11037
SEG
10009, 10036, 10037, 10217,
10218, 10264, 10362, 10487,
10668, 11037, 11163 SEI 10037, 10163
Sei-Sinudyne 10037
Seleco
10163, 10264, 10346, 10362,
10371 Semivox 10180
Semp 10156 Sencora 10009 Sentra 10035 Serino 10093, 10455, 10610 Shancha 10264, 10817
Shanghai
10009, 10208, 10226, 10264,
10817 Shaofeng 10145, 10817
Sharp
10054, 10093, 10180, 10053,
10030, 10009, 10036, 10200,
10650, 10653, 10668, 11193,
11393, 11917 Shen Ying 10092, 10009
Shencai 10145, 10009, 10264 Sheng Chia 10093, 10236, 10009 Shenyang 10009, 10264, 10817 Sherwood 10009 Shintoshi 10037
Shivaki
10178, 10037, 10374, 10443,
10556 Show 10009, 10418
Siarem 10163
Siemens
10145, 10037, 10195, 10200,
10327 Siera 10037, 10556
Siesta 10370 Signature 10047, 10093, 10030 Silva 10037, 10361, 10648 Silva Schneider 10037, 11556 Silvano 10587 Silver 10036, 10361, 10455, 10715 SilverCrest 11037
Simpson 10178, 10030, 10011
Singer
10060, 10092, 10009, 10037, 10335, 10371, 10433, 11537
Sinotec 10773 Sinudyne 10037, 10163, 10361 Skantic 10163 SKY 10037, 10880, 11504 Sky Brazil 10880 Sky-North 10037 Skygiant 10180
Skyworth
10748, 10009, 10037, 10264, 10698, 10805, 10817, 11115
Sliding 10865, 10880 SLX 10668 Smaragd 10487 Soemtron 10865, 11298 Solar Drape 10000 Solavox 10037, 10163, 10361, 10548 Sole 10813 Sonawa 10218 Songba 10009 Soniko 10037 Sonitron 10208, 10217, 10370 Sonneclair 10037 Sonoko 10009, 10037, 10217, 10264 Sonolor 10163, 10208, 10361, 10548 Sontec 10009, 10037, 10370
Sony
10017, 10154, 11100, 10000, 10150, 10053, 10011, 10036, 10037, 10074, 10353, 10650, 11505, 11651, 11751, 11904
Sound & Vision 10218, 10374 Soundesign 10180, 10178 Soundwave 10037, 10418, 10715 Sova 11952
Sowa
10156, 10051, 10060, 10178, 10092, 10036, 10226
Soyea 10773 Spectra 10009 Spectravision 10156, 10178 Spectroniq 11498 Squareview 10171 SR2000 10154, 10171 Ssangyong 10009 SSS 10180 Staksonic 10009
Standard
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10374, 11037
Standard Components
10009, 10218
Starlite
10236, 10180, 10009, 10037, 10163, 10264
Stenway 10218 Stern 10163, 10264 Stevison 11982 Strato 10009, 10037, 10264
Page 85
PRESET CODE
Strong 11149, 11163 Studio Experience 10843 Stylandia 10217
Sunkai
10218, 10455, 10487, 10610, 10865
Sunstar 10009, 10037, 10264, 10371 Sunwatt 10455 Sunwood 10037 Superla 10217 Superscan 10093, 10864, 11944 Supersonic 10009, 10208, 10455, 10805 SuperTech 10009, 10037, 10218, 10556 Supra 10178, 10009, 10374 Supreme 10000 Susumu 10218, 10287, 10335 Sutron 10009 SV2000 10054
SVA
10748, 10587, 10865, 10870, 10871, 10872
Svasa 10455 Swisstec 10880, 11504 Sydney 10217
Sylvania
10047, 10054, 10154, 10000, 10051, 10178, 10030, 10171, 10092, 10036, 10037, 10876, 11271, 11904, 11944
Symphonic
10000, 10180, 10178, 10171, 11904, 11944
Synco
10000, 10451, 10093, 10060, 10178, 10092, 10036
Syntax 11144, 11240, 11331 Sysline 10037
T
T+A 10447 Tacico 10178, 10092, 10009 Tai Yi 10009 Taishan 10009, 10374, 10817 Tandberg 10109, 10361, 10367 Tandy 10093, 10163, 10217, 10218 Targa 11371
Tashiko
10092, 10036, 10163, 10170, 10217, 10650
Tatung
10054, 10154, 10000, 10156, 10051, 10060, 10037, 10036, 10011, 10009, 10217, 11156, 11191, 11248, 11254, 11371, 11556, 11756
TCL 10706, 10698, 11027, 11537 TCM 10714, 10808
Teac
10154, 10178, 10171, 10706, 11755, 11149, 11037, 10714, 10712, 10698, 10668, 10512, 10455, 10418, 10264, 10217, 10170, 10037, 10009
Tec
10009, 10037, 10163, 10217, 10335
Tech Line 10037, 10668, 11163 Techica 10218 Technica 11982
Technics
10054, 10250, 10051, 10226, 10556, 10650
TechniSat 10556, 11267 Technisson 10714 Technosonic 10499, 10556 Technovox 10030, 10217 Techview 10847 Techwood 10250, 10051, 10060, 11163 Tecnimagen 10556
Teco
10051, 10093, 10178, 10092, 10009, 10036, 10218, 10264, 10653, 11040
Tedelex
10009, 10208, 10217, 10418, 10606, 10698, 11537
Teiron 10009 Tek 10820
Teknika
10054, 10463, 10180, 10150,
10060, 10178, 10092 Tele System Electronic
10876
Teleavia 10287, 10343 Telecolor 10017
Telecor
10037, 10163, 10217, 10218,
10394
Telefunken
10702, 11504, 10821, 10820,
10819, 10714, 10712, 10698,
10625, 10587, 10560, 10498,
10486, 10346, 10343, 10335,
10287, 10109, 10074, 10073,
10037 Telefusion 10037
Telegazi 10037, 10163, 10218, 10264 Telemeister 10037 Telesonic 10037 Telestar 10009, 10037, 10556 Teletech 10009, 10037, 10668, 11037 Teleton 10036, 10217 Televideon 10163 Teleview 10037 Tempest 10009, 10264, 10455 Tennessee 10037
Tensai
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10371, 10374, 10715, 11037 Tenson 10009
Tera 10030, 10092
Tevion
10037, 10556, 10648, 10668,
10714, 10808, 11037, 11137,
11248, 11298, 11498, 11556 Texet 10009, 10217, 10218, 10374
Texla 10780 ThemeScene 10887 Thomas 10047, 10178, 10001, 11904
Thomson
11447, 10047, 10037, 10109,
10287, 10335, 10343, 10560,
10625
Thorn
10035, 10036, 10037, 10073,
10074, 10109, 10163, 10264,
10335, 10343, 10361, 10499,
10512 Thorn-Ferguson 10073, 10335, 10343, 10499
Tiane 10093, 10817 Tiny 11269 TMK 10236, 10180, 10178 TML 11756 TNCi 10017 Tobishi 10218 Tobo 10748, 10009, 10264 Tocom 10156
Tokai
10009, 10037, 10163, 10217, 10374, 10668, 11037
Tokaido 11037 Tokyo 10035 Tomashi 10218 Tongguang 10264 Tongtel 10587, 10780 Topline 10668, 11037
Toshiba
10154, 11256, 10156, 10150, 11265, 10060, 11145, 10145, 10166, 11037, 11156, 11163, 11164, 11356, 11508, 11556, 11656, 11704, 11945, 11971, 10845, 10821, 10718, 10650, 10618, 10508, 10264, 10217, 10195, 10109, 10070, 10036, 10035, 10011, 10009
Totevision 10051 Towada 10217 Toyoda 10009, 10264, 10371 Toyomenka 10178 Trakton 10217, 10264 Trans Continens 10037, 10217, 10668, 11037 TRANS-continents 10556, 10865
Transonic
10009, 10037, 10264, 10418, 10455, 10512, 10587, 10698, 10712, 10780
Triad 10218, 10556 Trident 10217 Trio 11498 Tristar 10218, 10264 Triumph 10037, 10346, 10556 Truetone 10250, 10051 Tuntex 10030, 10092, 10009 TVS 10463 TVTEXT 95 10556
U
Uher
10037, 10370, 10374, 10418, 10480, 10486
Ultra 10092 Ultravox 10037, 10163, 10374 Unic Line 10037, 10455
United
10037, 10587, 10714, 10715, 11037, 11982
Universal 10047, 10037
Universum
11163, 11037, 10668, 10631, 10618, 10512, 10480, 10418, 10370, 10362, 10361, 10346, 10327, 10264, 10217, 10200, 10195, 10170, 10109, 10074, 10070, 10037, 10036, 10011, 10009
Univox 10037, 10163
V
V 10864, 10885, 11755, 11756 V2max 10865 V7 Videoseven 10880, 11217, 11755 Vector Research 10030
Vestel
10037, 10217, 10668, 11037, 11163
Vexa 10009, 10037
Victor
10250, 10053, 10036, 10650, 10653
Videocon 10508 Videologic 10218 Videologique 10217, 10218 Videomac 10009 VideoSystem 10037 Videotechnic 10217, 10374 Videoton 10163 Vidikron 10054 Vidtech 10178, 10036 Viewpia 10876
Viewsonic
10857, 10864, 10885, 11330, 11578, 11627, 11755
Viking 10060 Viore 11207 Vision 10037, 10217, 10264
Vizio
10864, 10885, 11755, 11756, 11758
Vortec 10037 Voxson 10178, 10037, 10163, 10418
W
Waltham
10037, 10109, 10217, 10418, 10443, 10668, 11037
Wards
10047, 10054, 10017, 10154, 10000, 10156, 10051, 10093, 10236, 10180, 10060, 10178, 10030, 10166, 11347, 11156, 11147, 10866, 10195, 10001, 10037, 10035
Warumaia 10374, 10661
Watson
10009, 10037, 10163, 10218, 10394, 10668, 10714, 11037
Watt Radio 10163 Waycon 10156 Wega 10036, 10037 Wegavox 10009 Weipai 10009 Welltech 10714 Weltblick 10217 Welton 10178 Weltstar 11037
Westinghouse
10000, 10451, 10885, 10889,
11282, 11577 Wharfedale 10037, 10556, 10860, 11556 White
Westinghouse
10451, 10236, 10463, 10037,
10623, 10889, 11909 Windsor 10668, 11037
Windy Sam 10556 Wintel 10714 World 10451, 10236, 10463, 10180
World-of-Vision
10865, 10877, 10880, 11217, 11298
Worldview 10455
X
X-View 11191 Xenius 10634, 10661
Xiahua
10009, 10264, 10698, 10773, 10817
Xianghai 10009 Xiangyang 10264 Xiangyu 10009 Xihu 10264, 10817 Xingfu 10009 Xinghai 10264 XLogic 10698, 10860 Xoceco 11064 Xoro 11196, 11217 XR-1000 10154, 10180, 10171 Xrypton 10037
Y
Yamaha 10030, 10650, 11576 Yamishi 10037, 10217, 10218, 10455 Yapshe 10250 Yingge 10009 Yokan 10037
Yoko
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10370
Yonggu 10009 Yorx 10030, 10218 Youlanasi 10817 Yousida 10009 Yuhang 10009
Z
Zanussi 10163, 10217, 10264
Zenith
10047, 10017, 10000, 10093, 10463, 11265, 10812, 10178, 10030, 11145, 10145, 10171, 10092, 10037, 11904, 11909, 11911
ZhuHai 10009, 10374
TV/DVD Combination b2, b4
b2
A
Advent 11933 Akai 11675 Akura 11982 Alba 11037 Amstrad 11982 Apex Digital 11943 Audiovox 11937, 11951, 11952 Axion 11937, 11958
B
Black Diamond 11037 Bush 10698, 11037, 11900
C
Centrum 11037 Crown 11037
D
D-Vision 11982 Denver 10587
Page 86
PRESET CODE
0
E
Elfunk 11037
F
Ferguson 11037 Finlux 11556
G
Goodmans 10587, 11037, 11900
H
Hitachi 11960
J
JDV 11982 Jensen 11933
K
KLH 11962
L
Lenco 10587 Logik 11037 Luker 11982 Luxor 11037
M
Matsui 11037 Maxim 11982 Medion 11900 Mirror 11900
N
Naiko 11982 Narita 11982
P
Panasonic 11941 Philips 11454, 10556, 11961 Powerpoint 10698 Prima 11933
R
RCA 11948, 11958 Roadstar 11900
S
Saivod 11982 Samsung 11903 Schneider 11982 SEG 11037 Sova 11952 Stevison 11982 Sylvania 10171
T
Teac 10698 Technica 11982 Telefunken 10698 Thomson 10625 Transonic 10587
U
United 10587, 11037, 11982
V
Vestel 11037
b4
A
Akai 30695 Akura 31367 Alba 30695, 30884 Amstrad 31367 Apex Digital 30830
B
Black Diamond 30713, 30884 Broksonic 30695 Bush 30713, 30884
C
Centrum 30713 Citizen 30695 Crown 30713
D
D-Vision 31367
DMTech 31271
E
Elfunk 30713, 30884 Emerson 30675, 31268 ESA 31268
F
Ferguson 30695, 30713, 30884 Funai 31268
G
Goodmans 30713 Grandin 30713 Grundig 30539, 30695
H
Hitachi 31247
I
Insignia 31268
J
JDV 31367 JNC 31271
K
Konka 31192
L
Logik 30713, 30884 Luker 31367 Luxor 30713
M
Magnavox 31268 Matsui 30713, 30884 Maxim 31367
N
Naiko 31367 Narita 31367 Neovia 31271
O
Orion 30695
P
Pacific 30695 Panasonic 31490 Philips 30539, 30854, 31260
R
RCA 31022
S
Saivod 31367 Samsung 30899 Sansui 30695 Schneider 31367 SEG 30713, 30884 Sliding 31115 Stevison 31367 Sylvania 30630, 30675, 31268
T
Technica 31367 Thomson 30551 Toshiba 30695
U
United 30713, 30884, 31367 Universum 30713
V
Vestel 30884
TV/VCR Combination b2, b3, b4
b2
A
Aiwa 11904, 11911 America Action 10180 Amstrad 10171 Audiovox 10180
B
Beko 10486 Black Diamond 11909
Broksonic 10463, 11911 Bush 11556
C
Curtis Mathes 10051
D
Daewoo 11909
E
Emerson 10236, 10463, 11909, 11911
F
Ferguson 10073, 10625 Fidelity 10171 Funai 11904
G
GE
10047, 10051, 10093, 11917, 11922
GoldStar 10037 Goodmans 10374, 11909 Grundig 10037, 10195, 10556
H
Harley Davidson 11904 Hinari 10036 Hitachi 11904
I
Internal 11909
J
JVC 11923
L
LG 10178 Lloyd’s 11904
M
Magnavox 10054, 11904 Memorex 10250 Mitsubishi 10093, 10556, 11917
O
Orion 10463, 11911
P
Palsonic 11904 Panasonic 10250, 10051 Penney 10051 Philips 10037, 10556
Q
Quasar 10250, 10051
R
Radiola 10556 RadioShack 11904
RCA
10047, 10051, 10093, 11917, 11922
S
Saba 10625 Samsung 11959 Sansui 10463, 11904, 11911 Schneider 10037, 10556, 11904 Sears 11904 Sharp 10093, 11917 Siemens 10037 Sony 10000, 11505, 11904 Sylvania 10054 Symphonic 11904
T
Teac 10178, 10171 Technics 10556 Thomas 11904 Thomson 10625 Toshiba 11971
W
White Westinghouse
11909
Z
Zenith 11904, 11909, 11911
b3
A
Aiwa
20000, 20352, 20479, 20742, 21137
Akai 20352 Alba 20352 America Action 20278 Amstrad 20000 Audiovox 20278
B
Beko 20104 Bestar 20278 Blue Sky 20278, 20352, 20742 BPL 20046 Broksonic 20002, 20479, 21479 Bush 20352, 20742
C
Citizen 20278, 21278 Curtis Mathes 20035, 21035
D
Daewoo 20278, 20637, 21278 Dantax 20352
E
Emerson
20002, 20278, 20479, 20637,
21278, 21479
F
Ferguson 20000, 20278 Fidelity 20000 Firstline 20278 Funai 20000
G
GE
20060, 20035, 20048, 20240,
20807, 21035, 21060 GoldStar 20037, 20480, 21237
Goodmans 20278, 20352, 20637 Grandin 20278, 20742 Grundig 20081, 20347, 20352, 20742
H
Hanimex 20352 Harley Davidson 20000 Hinari 20352 Hitachi 20000 Hypson 20037
I
Internal 20278, 20637
J
JBL 20278 JMB 20352
K
Kambrook 20037 Kneissel 20278, 20352
L
LG 20037, 20480, 21237 Lloyd’s 20000 Loewe 20037
M
Magnasonic 20278, 21278 Magnavox 20081, 20000, 21781 Magnin 20240 Matsui 20352, 20742 Medion 20352
Memorex
20162, 20037, 21162, 21237,
21262 MGA 20240
Mitsubishi 20048, 20081, 20043, 20807
O
Optimus 20162, 21162, 21262
Orion
20002, 20352, 20479, 20742,
21479
P
Pace 20352 Pacific 20742
Palsonic 20000
Panasonic
20035, 20162, 21035, 21162, 21262
Penney
20035, 20037, 20240, 21035, 21237
Philips 20081 Portland 20637
Q
Quasar 20035, 20162, 21035, 21162
R
Radiola 20081 RadioShack 20000
RCA
20060, 20035, 20048, 20240, 20807, 21035, 21060
S
Saba 20320 Samsung 20240, 20432, 21014 Sansui 20000, 20479, 21479 Sanyo 20240 Saville 20352 Schneider 20081, 20000 Sears 20037, 20000, 21237 SEG 20637 Sharp 20037, 20048, 20807 Shivaki 20037 Siemens 20081 Sinudyne 20352 Sony 20032, 20000, 21232 Supra 20348 Sylvania 20081, 21781 Symphonic 20000
T
Tatung 20352 Teac 20037, 20000, 20637, 20642 Technics 20081 Technosonic 20352 Telefunken 20278 Thomas 20000 Thomson 20278 Toshiba 20352, 20432, 20845, 21145
U
United 20742
W
White Westinghouse
20278, 20637
Z
Zenith 20000, 20479, 20637, 21479
b4
T
Thomson 30551
TV/VCR/DVD Combination b2, b3, b4
b2
A
Akai 11903
B
Broksonic 11938
E
Emerson 11944 ESA 11944
M
Magnavox 11944
P
Panasonic 11946, 11947
R
RCA 11953
Page 87
PRESET CODE

S
Sharp 11917 Sylvania 11944 Symphonic 11944
T
Toshiba 11945
b3
S
Sharp 20807
b4
A
Akai 30899
E
Emerson 30821 ESA 30821
M
Magnavox 30821
P
Panasonic 31362, 31462
R
RCA 31132
S
Sharp 30630 Superscan 30821 Sylvania 30821 Symphonic 30821
T
Toshiba 31045
VCR
A
A-Mark
20037, 20240, 20000, 20278, 20046
ABS 21972
Admiral
20060, 20048, 20039, 20047, 20104, 20121, 20209, 20479
Adventura 20037, 20240, 20000 Aiko 20278 Aim 20278, 20348, 20642
Aiwa
20037, 20032, 20000, 20209, 20041, 20348, 20352, 20479, 20742, 21137
Akai
20037, 20240, 20041, 20106, 20315, 20348, 20352, 20642
Akura 20041
Alba
20081, 20000, 20209, 20278, 20315, 20348, 20352
Alienware 21972 Allegro 20039, 21137 Allorgan 20240 Allstar 20081 America Action 20278 American High 20035, 20081 Amoisonic 20479 Amstrad 20000, 20278
Anam
20162, 20037, 20240, 20278, 20226, 20480
Anam National 20162, 20226, 21162, 21562 Ansonic 20000 Aristona 20081 ASA 20037, 20081 Asha 20240 Astra 20035, 20240 Asuka 20037, 20081, 20000, 20038
Audiolab 20081 Audiosonic 20278 Audiovox 20037, 20278, 20038 Avis 20000 AVP 20000, 20352 Awa 20037, 20043, 20278, 20642
B
Baird
20000, 20104, 20041, 20278, 20046, 20106
Basic Line 20104, 20278, 20046 Beaumark 20240 Beko 20104
Bell & Howell
20035, 20048, 20039, 20000, 20104, 20046, 20479
Bestar 20278 Black Diamond 20642 Black Panther 20278 Blaupunkt 20162, 20081, 20226
Blue Sky
20037, 20209, 20278, 20348, 20352, 20480, 20642, 20742, 21137
BPL 20046 Brandt 20041, 20320 Brandt Electronique 20041 Brinkmann 20209, 20348
Broksonic
20184, 20121, 20209, 20002, 20348, 20479, 21479
Bush
20081, 20000, 20209, 20278, 20315, 20348, 20352, 20642, 20742
C
Calix 20037 Candle 20037, 20038 Canon 20035 Capehart 20002 Carena 20081, 20209 Carrefour 20045 Carrera 20240 Carver 20035, 20081 Casio 20000 Cathay 20278 CCE 20278 CGE 20000, 20041 Changhong 20048, 20081 Cimline 20209 Cineral 20278 CineVision 21137
Citizen
20035, 20037, 20240, 20000, 20209, 20278, 20479, 21278
Classic 20037 Clatronic 20000, 21593 Colortyme 20060, 20035, 20045, 20278 Colt 20000 Combitech 20352 Condor 20278 Craig 20037, 20047, 20240 Criterion 20000
Crosley 20035, 20081, 20000 Crown 20037, 20278, 20480
Curtis Mathes
20060, 20035, 20162, 20240, 20000, 20041, 20278, 20432, 21035
Cybernex 20240 CyberPower 21972 Cyrus 20081
D
Daewoo
20037, 20045, 20104, 20209, 20278, 20046, 20352, 20637, 20642, 21137, 21278
Dansai 20278 Dantax 20352 Daytron 20037, 20278
De Graaf
20048, 20081, 20042, 20104, 20046
Decca
20081, 20000, 20067, 20209, 20041, 20352
Degraff 20048, 20081, 20042, 20104 Deitron 20278 Dell 21972 Denon 20081, 20042 Derwent 20041 Diamant 20037 Diamond 20348 Digitor 20642 DirecTV 20739 Domland 20209 DSE 20642
Dual
20081, 20000, 20041, 20278, 20348
Dumont 20081, 20000, 20104 Durabrand 20039, 20038, 20642 Dynatech 20240, 20000
E
Elbe 20278, 20038
Electrohome
20060, 20037, 20240, 20000, 20043, 20209
Electrophonic 20037 Elin 20240 Elta 20278 Emerald 20184, 20121 Emerex 20032
Emerson
20035, 20037, 20184, 20039, 20240, 20045, 20000, 20121, 20043, 20209, 20002, 20278, 20348, 20479, 20637, 21278, 21479, 21593
ESA 21137 ESC 20240, 20278 EuroLine 21593
F
Ferguson
20000, 20041, 20278, 20320, 20348
Fidelity 20240, 20000, 20352, 20432
Finlandia
20037, 20048, 20081, 20000, 20042, 20104, 20043, 20046, 20106, 20226
Finlux 20081, 20000, 20042, 20104
Firstline
20037, 20045, 20042, 20043,
20209, 20278, 20348, 20480,
21137
Fisher
20039, 20047, 20000, 20104,
20046 Flint 20209, 20348
Fuji 20035, 20033 Fujitsu 20037, 20045, 20000 Fujitsu General 20037 Funai 20037, 20000, 20278, 21593
G
Galaxi 20000 Galaxis 20278 Garrard 20000 Gateway 21972
GE
20060, 20035, 20048, 20240,
20000, 20226, 20320, 20807,
21035, 21060 GEC 20081
Gemini 20060 General 20045 General Technic 20348 Genexxa 20037, 20000, 20104, 20278 Go Video 20240, 20432, 20614, 21137
GoldStar
20035, 20037, 20039, 20000,
20209, 20278, 20038, 20225,
20226, 20480, 21137, 21237
Goodmans
20037, 20081, 20240, 20000,
20209, 20278, 20348, 20352,
20637, 20642, 20742 GPX 20037
Gradiente 20000 Graetz 20240, 20104, 20041
Granada
20035, 20037, 20048, 20081,
20240, 20000, 20042, 20104,
20046, 20226
Grandin
20037, 20000, 20209, 20278,
20742
Grundig
20081, 20226, 20320, 20347,
20348, 20352, 20742
H
Haaz 20348 Hanimex 20352 Hanseatic 20037, 20081, 20209, 20038 Haojie 20240 Harley Davidson 20000 Harman/Kardon 20081, 20038 Headquarter 20046 Hewlett Packard 21972 HI-Q 20035, 20047, 20000
Hinari
20240, 20209, 20041, 20278,
20352 Hisawa 20209, 2035
Hischito 20045
Hitachi
20035, 20037, 20081, 20240,
20045, 20000, 20042, 20041,
20046, 20089 Hoeher 20278, 20642
Hornyphon 20081 Howard Computers 21972 HP 21972
Hughes Network Systems
20042, 20739
Humax 20739 Hush 21972
Hypson
20037, 20000, 20209, 20278, 20352, 20480
Hytek 20047, 20000
I
iBUYPOWER 21972 Imperial 20000 Ingersol 20240, 20209 Interbuy 20037 Interfunk 20081, 20104 Internal 20278, 20637 International 20037, 20278, 20642
Intervision
20037, 20000, 20209, 20278, 20348
Irradio 20037, 20081, 21137
ITT
20240, 20104, 20041, 20046, 20106
ITT Nokia 20240, 20104, 20041, 20106 ITV 20037, 20278
J
Janeil 20240 JBL 20278 Jensen 20067, 20041 JMB 20209, 20348, 20352, 20742 Joyce 20000
JVC
20184, 20081, 20045, 20067, 20041, 21162
K
Kambrook 20037 Karcher 20081, 20278, 20642 KEC 20037, 20278
Kendo
20037, 20209, 20278, 20106, 20315, 20348, 20642
Kenwood 20067, 20041, 20038, 20046 KIC 20000 Kimari 20047
Kneissel
20037, 20209, 20278, 20348, 20352
Kodak 20035, 20037 Kolin 20043, 20041 Kolster 20209 KTV 20000 Kuba 20047 Kuba Electronic 20047
L
Lenco 20278
LG
20037, 20240, 20045, 20000, 20042, 20209, 20278, 20038, 20225, 20480, 21137, 21237
Lifetec 20209, 20348 Linksys 21972 Lloyd’s 20240, 20000, 20038
Loewe
21062, 20162, 20037, 20081, 21262, 21562
Logik 20240, 20000, 20209, 20106 Lumatron 20278, 21137 Lunatron 21137
Page 88
PRESET CODE

Luxor
20048, 20047, 20104, 20043, 20046, 20106, 20315
LXI 20037, 20000, 20042, 20067
M
M Electronic 20037, 20240, 20000, 20038 Magnadyne 20081
Magnasonic
20037, 20240, 20000, 20278, 21278
Magnavox
20035, 20037, 20048, 20039, 20081, 20240, 20000, 20226, 20618, 20642, 21593, 21781
Magnin 20240 Magnum 20642 Manesth 20081, 20045, 20209 Marantz 20035, 20081, 20209, 20038 Mark 20000, 20278 Marta 20037 Mastec 20642 Master’s 20278
Matsui
20037, 20240, 20209, 20278, 20348, 20352, 20742
Matsushita
20035, 20162, 20081, 20226, 21162
Media Center PC 21972 Mediator 20081 Medion 20209, 20348, 20352, 20642 MEI 20035
Memorex
20035, 20162, 20037, 20048, 20039, 20047, 20240, 20000, 20104, 20209, 20278, 20046, 20348, 20479, 21162, 21237, 21262
Metronic 20081
Metz
21062, 20162, 20037, 20081, 20226, 20347, 20836, 21162, 21262, 21562
MGA 20060, 20240, 20043 MGN Technology 20240 Micormay 20348 Micromaxx 20209 Microsoft 21972 Midland 20240 Migros 20000 Mind 21972 Minolta 20042
Mitsubishi
20060, 20048, 20047, 20081, 20000, 20042, 20067, 20043, 20041, 20480, 20642, 20807
Motorola 20035, 20048 MTC 20240, 20000 MTX 20000 Multitec 20037 Multitech 20039, 20000 Murphy 20000 Myryad 20081
N
NAD 20240, 20104 Naiko 20348, 20642 NAP 20039 National 20226
Nebula Electronics 20033
NEC
20035, 20037, 20048, 20104, 20067, 20041, 20278, 20038, 21137
Neckermann 20081, 20041 Nesco 20000 Neufunk 20209 Newave 20037 Nikkai 20278 Nikko 20037, 20278 Nikkodo 20037, 20278 Nishi 20240 Niveus Media 21972 Noblex 20240
Nokia
20048, 20081, 20240, 20042, 20104, 20041, 20278, 20046, 20106, 20315
Nordmende 20067, 20041, 20320 Northgate 21972 Nu-Tec 20209
O
Oceanic
20048, 20081, 20000, 20104, 20041, 20046, 20106
Okano 20209, 20278, 20315, 20348 Olympus 20035, 20162, 20104, 20226 Onimax 20642 Onkyo 20222
Optimus
21062, 20035, 20162, 20037, 20048, 20047, 20240, 20000, 20104, 20432, 21162, 21262
Orion
20184, 20240, 20000, 20104, 20121, 20209, 20002, 20278, 20348, 20352, 20479, 20742, 21479
Orson 20000 Osaki 20037, 20000 Otake 20209 Otto Versand 20081
P
Pace 20352 Pacific 20000, 20348, 20642, 20742 Packard Bell 21972 Palladium 20037, 20209, 20041, 20348 Palsonic 20000, 20642 Panama 20035
Panasonic
21062, 20035, 20162, 20000, 20225, 20226, 20614, 20616, 20836, 21035, 21162, 21262, 21562
Pathe Cinema 20043 Pathe Marconi 20041
Penney
20035, 20162, 20037, 20047, 20081, 20240, 20000, 20042, 20067, 20038, 21035, 21237
Pentax 20042 Perdio 20000, 20209
Philco
20035, 20081, 20000, 20209, 20038, 20226, 20479
Philips
20035, 20162, 20048, 20081, 20045, 20000, 20209, 20226, 20616, 20618, 20739, 21081, 21181
Phoenix 20278 Phonola 20081 Pilot 20037 Pioneer 20162, 20081, 20042, 20067 Polk Audio 20081 Portland 20278, 20637 Presidian 21593 Prinz 20000 Profitronic 20081, 20240 Proline 20000, 20278, 20320, 20642 Proscan 20060, 21060 Prosco 20278 Prosonic 20209, 20278 Protec 20000 Protech 20081 ProVision 20278 Pulsar 20039, 20240, 20278 Pulser 20240 Pye 20081, 20000
Q
Qisheng 20060 Quarter 20046 Quartz 20035, 20047, 20046
Quasar
20035, 20162, 20002, 20278, 20226, 21035, 21162
Quelle 20081
R
Radialva 20037, 20048, 20081 Radiola 20081 Radionette 20037, 21137
RadioShack
20035, 20162, 20037, 20048, 20047, 20240, 20000, 20104, 20046, 21162
Radix 20037 Randex 20037 Rank 20041 Rank Arena 20041
RCA
20060, 20035, 20048, 20240, 20045, 20000, 20042, 20106, 20226, 20320, 20807, 20880, 21035, 21060
Realistic
20035, 20162, 20037, 20048, 20047, 20240, 20000, 20104, 20121, 20278, 20046, 21162
Reoc 20348 ReplayTV 20614, 20616 Rex 20041 Ricavision 21972 Rio 21137
Roadstar
20037, 20081, 20240, 20278, 20038, 20742
Runco 20039
S
Saba 20041, 20278, 20320 Saisho 20209, 20348 Salora 20104, 20043, 20046, 20106
Sampo 20037, 20048
Samsung
20060, 20240, 20045, 20000,
20038, 20432, 20739, 21014 Samtron 20240
Sanky 20048, 20039 Sansei 20048
Sansui
20240, 20000, 20067, 20209,
20041, 20002, 20106, 20348,
20479, 21479
Sanyo
20048, 20047, 20240, 20000,
20104, 20067, 20209, 20046,
20348, 20479, 21137 Saville 20240, 20278, 20352
SBR 20081 ScanSonic 20240
Schaub Lorenz
20000, 20104, 20041, 20106,
20315, 20348
Schneider
20037, 20081, 20240, 20000,
20042, 20278, 20348, 20352,
20642, 21137 Scott 20184, 20045, 20121, 20043
Sears
20060, 20035, 20162, 20037,
20048, 20039, 20047, 20033,
20045, 20000, 20042, 20104,
20067, 20043, 20209, 20041,
21237, 20046 Seaway 20278
SEG
20081, 20240, 20278, 20637,
20642 SEI 20081
Sei-Sinudyne 20081 Seleco 20037, 20041 Semp 20045 Sentra 20278
Sharp
20037, 20048, 20047, 20032,
20000, 20209, 20807 Shinco 20000
Shintom 20039, 20240, 20000, 20104 Shivaki 20037 Shogun 20240
Siemens
20037, 20081, 20104, 20046,
20320, 20347 Siera 20081
Signature
20060, 20035, 20037, 20048,
20000, 20046, 20479 Silva 20037
Silver 20278 SilverCrest 20642 Singer 20037, 20240, 20045, 20348 Sinudyne 20081, 20209, 20352 Smaragd 20348 Sonic Blue 20614, 20616, 21137 Sonographe 20046 Sonolor 20048, 20046 Sontec 20037, 20278 Sonwa 20642
Sony
20035, 20048, 20047, 20032,
20033, 20000, 20067, 20046,
20106, 20226, 20636, 21232,
21972
Soundmaster 20000 Soundwave 20037, 20209, 20348 Stack 9 21972 Standard 20278 Stern 20278 STS 20042 Sunkai 20209, 20278, 20348 Sunstar 20000 Suntronic 20000 Supra 20037, 20278, 20348 Susumu 20037 SV2000 20000 SVA 20000
Sylvania
20035, 20081, 20000, 20043, 21593, 21781
Symphonic 20240, 20000, 20002, 21593 Systemax 21972
T
T+A 20162 Tagar Systems 21972 Taisho 20209 Tandberg 20278 Tandy 20000, 20104
Tashiko
20037, 20048, 20081, 20240, 20000
Tatung
20048, 20081, 20045, 20000, 20067, 20043, 20209, 20041, 20348, 20352
Tchibo 20348 TCM 20348
Teac
20037, 20000, 20067, 20041, 20278, 20637, 20642, 21593
Technics
20035, 20162, 20037, 20081, 20000, 20226, 21162
TechniSat 20348 Technosonic 20352
Teco
20035, 20037, 20048, 20041, 20038
Tedelex 20037, 20209, 20348, 20642 Teknika 20035, 20037, 20000 Teleavia 20041 Telecorder 20240
Telefunken
20209, 20041, 20278, 20320, 20642
Telerent 20226 Telestar 20037 Teletech 20000, 20278 Tensai 20037, 20000, 20278 Tevion 20209, 20348, 20479, 20642 Texet 20278 Thomas 20000, 20002
Thomson
20060, 20067, 20041, 20278, 20320
Thorn 20037, 20104, 20041, 20320 Tisonic 20278 Tivo 20618, 20636, 20739, 21996 TMK 20240, 20000
Page 89
PRESET CODE

TNIX 20037 Tocom 20240 Tokai 20037, 20104, 20041 Topline 20348
Toshiba
20081, 20240, 20045, 20000, 20042, 20067, 20043, 20209, 20041, 20352, 20432, 20742, 20845, 21008, 21145, 21972, 21996
Tosonic 20278 Totevision 20037, 20240 Touch 21972 Toyoda 20278 Tradex 20081 Triad 20278 Trix 20037
U
Uher 20240 Ultra 20045, 20278 Ultravox 20278 Unitech 20240 United 20348, 20742, 21593
Universum
20037, 20081, 20240, 20000, 20104, 20209, 20106, 20348, 21137
V
Vector 20045 Vector Research 20184, 20038 Victor 20067, 20041 Video Concepts 20045 Video Technic 20000 Videomagic 20037 Videosonic 20240, 20000 Viewsonic 21972 Villain 20000 Voodoo 21972
W
Wards
20060, 20035, 20037, 20048, 20039, 20047, 20081, 20033, 20240, 20045, 20000, 20042, 20043, 20041, 20038, 20046, 20479
Watson 20081, 20352, 20642 Weltblick 20037 Wharfedale 20642
White Westinghouse
20000, 20209, 20278, 20479, 20637
World 20209, 20002, 20348, 20479
X
XR-1000 20035, 20240, 20000
Y
Yamaha 20041, 20038 Yamishi 20278 Yoko 20037, 20240
Z
Zenith
20037, 20039, 20033, 20000, 20209, 20041, 20278, 20479, 20637, 21137, 21479
ZT Group 21972 ZX 20209, 20348, 20352
PVR b3
A
ABS 21972 Alienware 21972
C
CyberPower 21972
D
Dell 21972 DirecTV 20739
G
Gateway 21972 Go Video 20614
H
Hewlett Packard 21972 Howard Computers 21972 HP 21972
Hughes Network Systems
20739
Humax 20739 Hush 21972
I
iBUYPOWER 21972
L
Linksys 21972
M
Media Center PC 21972 Microsoft 21972 Mind 21972
N
Niveus Media 21972 Northgate 21972
P
Panasonic 20614, 20616 Philips 20618, 20739
R
RCA 20880 ReplayTV 20614, 20616
S
Samsung 20739 Sonic Blue 20614, 20616 Sony 20636, 21972 Stack 9 21972 Systemax 21972
T
Tagar Systems 21972 Tivo 20618, 20636, 20739 Toshiba 21008, 21972, 21996 Touch 21972
V
Viewsonic 21972 Voodoo 21972
Z
ZT Group 21972
DVD Player
1
3D LAB 30503, 30539 4Kus 31158
A
A-Trend 30714 Acoustic Solutions 30713, 30730, 31228 AEG 30770, 30788, 30790, 31923 AFK 31051, 31152, 31923 Aim 30672, 30699, 30833
Airis
30672, 31005, 31224, 31250, 31321, 31345
Aiwa 30533, 30641
Akai
30690, 30695, 30705, 30770, 30788, 30790, 30884, 30898, 30899, 31115, 31205, 31233, 31695
Akashi 30838 AKI 31005 Akira 30699, 31321
Akura
30898, 31051, 31140, 31233, 31367
Alba
30672, 30539, 30717, 30695, 30699, 30713, 30730, 30783, 30884, 31140, 31530, 31695
Alco 30790 Alize 31151 All-Tel 31451 Allegro 30869 Altacom 31224 Amitech 30784, 30770, 30850 Amoi 30852
Amphion Media Works
30872
Amstrad 30713, 30770, 31151, 31367 AMW 30872 Anam 31913 Ansonic 30759, 30774, 30831
Apex Digital
30533, 30672, 30717, 30755, 30794, 30796, 30797, 30830, 31004, 31020, 31056, 31061
Aristona 30539, 30646 Arrgo 31023 ASCOMTEC 31923 Asono 31224 Aspire Digital 31168 Atacom 31224 Audiosonic 30690, 31923 Audiovox 30717, 30790 Audioworld 30790 Autovox 30713 Auvio 30843 Awa 30730, 30872 Axion 30730
B
Base 31451 Basic Line 30713 Baze 30898 BBK 30862, 31224 Beep 31163 Bellagio 31004 Belson 31086, 31923 Binatone 31923 Black Diamond 30713, 30833, 30884 Blaupunkt 30717 Blu:sens 31233, 31321
Blue Nova International
31321
Blue Parade 30571
Blue Sky
30672, 30651, 30695, 30699,
30713, 30790, 30843, 31423 Boghe 31004
Boman 30783, 30898, 31005 Bose 32023 Brainwave 30770, 31115 Brandt 30503, 30651, 30551 Broksonic 30695
Bush
30672, 30717, 30690, 30699,
30713, 30723, 30730, 30831,
30833, 30884, 31051, 31140,
31483, 31695, 31832 Byd:sign 30872
C
C-Tech 30798, 31152 California Audio Labs
30490 Cambridge Audio 30751, 31109
Cambridge Soundworks
30690
Campomatic Digital 31051 Cat 30699, 30789, 31421, 31923 CCE 30730 Celestial 31020 cello 31730 Centrex 30672, 31004
Centrum
30713, 30789, 31005, 31227,
31923 CGV 30751, 31115
Changhong 30627, 31061 Cinea 30831, 30841 Cinetec 30713, 30872 cineULTRA 30699 CineVision 30833, 30869, 31483 Citizen 30695 Clairtone 30571 Classic 30730, 31730 Clatronic 30672, 30675, 30788, 31233 Clayton 30713
Coby
30730, 30852, 31086, 31321,
31923 Codex 31233
Commax 31321 Conia 30672, 30852, 31321 Contel 30788 Continental Edison 30831, 30872 Craig 30831 Creative 30503, 30539 Crown 30690, 30713, 30770, 31115 Crypto 31228 Curtis Mathes 31087 Cybercom 30831
CyberHome
30714, 30816, 30874, 31023,
31024, 31117, 31129, 31502 Cytron 30651, 30705, 30774, 31347
D
D-Vision 31115, 31367 Daenyx 30872
Daewoo
30490, 30784, 30705, 30714, 30770, 30833, 30869, 30872, 31172, 31483, 31906
Dalton 31036 Dansai 30770, 30783, 31115, 31695 Dantax 30539, 30713, 30723, 30790 Daytek 30872, 31005 Dayton 30872 DCE 30831 Decca 30770, 31115
Denon
30490, 30634, 31634,
[32134]
z
Denver
30672, 30699, 30788, 30898, 31056, 31104, 31321, 31923
Denzel 30665 Desay 30843, 31212 Dgtec 30672 Diamond 30651, 30751, 30768, 30790 Digihome 30713 DigiLogic 30713 digiRED 30717 Digitech 31832
Digitor
30651, 30690, 30833, 31005, 31423
Digitrex 30672, 31004, 31056 DiK 30831 Dinamic 30788 Disney 30675, 30831, 31270 DiViDo 30705 DK Digital 30831 DMTech 30783, 31271 Dragon 30831 DreamX 31151 DSE 30833, 31152, 31730
Dual
30651, 30665, 30675, 30713, 30730, 30783, 30790, 30831, 31023
Durabrand 30713, 30831, 31023, 31502 DVD2000 30521 DVX 30768
E
E:max 31233, 31321 EagleTec 30714 eBench 31152 ECC 30730 Eclipse 30723, 30751 Elfunk 30713, 30850, 30884 Elin 30770 Elite 31152 Ellion 30850, 31421
Elta
30672, 30690, 30770, 30788, 30850, 31051, 31115, 31151, 31233
Eltax 31233, 31321
Emerson
30591, 30675, 30705, 30821, 31268
Enterprise 30591
Page 90
PRESET CODE

Entivo 30503, 30539 Enzer 30784, 30770, 31228 ESA 30821, 31268 EuroLine 30675, 30788, 31115, 31233
F
Fenner 30651
Ferguson
30651, 30695, 30713, 30884, 30898, 31695, 31730
Finlux
30672, 30591, 30741, 30751, 30770, 30783
Firstline
30651, 30713, 30843, 30869, 31530
Fisher 30670 Funai 30675, 30695, 31268 Fusion 30862
G
Gateway 31158 GE 30522, 30815, 30717 General Electric 30717 Germatic 31051 Global Link 31224 Global Solutions 30768 Global Sphere 31152
Go Video
30573, 30744, 30717, 30715, 30741, 30783, 30833, 30869, 31044, 31075, 31099, 31158, 31483, 31730
GoldStar 30591, 30741, 30869
Goodmans
30651, 30690, 30713, 30723, 30730, 30783, 30790, 30833, 31004, 31140, 31423, 31530, 31730, 31923
GP Audio 31140 GPX 30699, 30741 Gradiente 30490, 30651 Graetz 30665 Gran Prix 30831, 30898 Grandin 30713, 31233 Greenhill 30717
Grundig
30539, 30651, 30551, 30670, 30686, 30695, 30705, 30713, 30775, 30790, 31004, 31036, 31695, 31730, 31832, 31920
Grunkel 30770, 30790, 30831
H
H & B
30713, 30841, 30850, 31233, 31421
Haaz 30751, 31152 Haier 30843 Hanseatic 30741, 30783, 30790 Harman/Kardon 30582, 30702 HCM 30788 HDT 30705 HE 30730, 31163, 31923 Henss 30713 HiMAX 30843
Hitachi
30573, 30664, 30665, 30713, 31247, 31920
Hiteker 30672, 31923
Hoeher
30651, 30713, 30831, 31004, 31224
Home Electronics 30730, 30770 Home Tech Industries
31224 Hoyo 30665 Humax 30646 Hyundai 30783, 30850, 31061, 31228
I
iLo 31348 Ingelen 30788 Ingersol 31023 Initial 30839, 30717 Inno Hit 30713 Insignia 31268 Integra 30571, 30627, 31634 Irradio 30869, 31115, 31224, 31233 IRT 30783 ISP 30695
J
Jamo 31036 Jaton 30665 JBL 30702 JDB 30730 JDV 31367 Jeken 30699 Jepssen 31250 JMB 30695 JNC 30672, 31271 JSI 31423
JVC
30503, 30539, 30558, 30623,
30867, 31164, 31597, 31860 jWin 31051
K
Kansas Technologies 31233, 31530 Karcher 30783 Kawasaki 30790 Kendo 30672, 30699, 30713, 30831 Kennex 30713, 30770, 30898 Kenwood 30490, 30534 Kiiro 30770 Kiss 30665, 30841, 31523 KLH 30815, 30717, 30790, 31020 Kloss 30533 Koda 31230 Konka 31192 Koss 30651, 31061, 31423 Kreisen 31421 KXD 31321, 31923
L
Lasonic 30627, 30798, 30789 Lawson 30768 Lecson 31533 Leiker 30872
Lenco
30651, 30699, 30713, 30770,
30774 Lenoir 31228
Lenoxx 30690, 30838 Lexia 30699, 30768
LG
30591, 30741, 30790, 30869, 31906
Lifetec 30651, 30831, 31347 Limit 30768, 31104 LiteOn 31058, 31158 Lodos 30713 Loewe 30539, 30511, 30741, 30885 Logik 30713, 30884 Logix 30705, 30783 Luker 31367
Lumatron
30695, 30705, 30713, 30741, 30833, 31115, 31321, 31832
Lunatron 30741 Luxman 30573 Luxor 30713, 31004, 31695, 31730
M
Magnasonic 30651, 30675 Magnat 31923
Magnavox
30503, 30539, 30646, 30675, 30713, 30821, 30885, 31140, 31268
Magnex 30723 Majestic 31345 Manhattan 30705, 30713 Marantz 30503, 30539, 30675 Mark 30713 Marquant 30770
Matsui
30672, 30651, 30695, 30713, 30884, 31004, 31695, 31730
Maxdorf 30788 Maxent 31347 Maxim 30713, 30872, 31367 Maya 31345 MBO 30690, 30730, 31730 McIntosh 31533 MDS 30713 Mecotek 30770
Medion
30651, 30630, 30774, 30783, 30831, 31006, 31270, 31345, 31347, 31423
MEI 30790 Memorex 30690, 30695, 30831, 31270 Metronic 30690 Metz 30525, 30571, 30713 MiCO 30723, 30751, 31223 Micromaxx 31695 Micromedia 30503, 30539 Micromega 30539, 31005 Microsoft 30522, 31708 Microstar 30831 Minato 30752 Minax 30713 Minerva 30705 Minoka 30770, 31115 Mintek 30839, 30717 Mirror 30752
Mitsubishi 31521, 30521, 30713, 31403 Mizuda 30770, 31451 Monyka 30665 MPX 30843 Mustek 30730, 31730 Mx Onda 30651, 30751, 31223 Mystral 30831
N
NAD 30741 Naiko 30770, 31004, 31367 Narita 31367 NEC 30741, 30869, 31404 Neovia 31271 Nesa 30717 Neufunk 30665 Nevir 30770, 30831, 31197 NexxTech 31402 Nikkai 31923 Nintaus 31051, 31202 Niro 32024 Norcent 30872, 31923 Nordmende 30774, 30831 Noriko 30752 Nova 31923 Nowa 30843 Nu-Tec 31228
O
Okano 30752 Olidata 30672
Omni
30690, 30833, 30838, 30862, 31104, 31832
Onix 30838 Onkyo 30503, 30627 Oopla 31158 Oppo 31224 Optim 30843 Optimus 30525, 30571 Orbit 30872 Orion 30695, 31233, 31695 Oritron 30651 Ormond 30713
P
P&B 31451
Pacific
30695, 30713, 30759, 30768, 30790, 30831
Packard Bell 30831 Palladium 30695, 30713, 31906, 31920 Palsonic 30672, 30852, 31056, 31321
Panasonic
30503, 30490, 30571, 30703, 31362, 31462, 31490, 31579, 31762, 31834, 31905, 31908
Panda 30717, 30789, 31203 peeKTon 30898, 31224 Philco 30690, 30862
Philips
30503, 30539, 30646, 30675, 30854, 30885, 31158, 31260, 31267, 31340, 31354
Philo 31345 Phonotrend 30699 PianoDisc 31024
Pioneer
30490, 30525, 30571, 30631, 31965
Plu2 30850 Pointer 30784 Polaroid 31020, 31061, 31086 Polk Audio 30539 Portland 30770 Powerpoint 30872, 31005 Presidian 30675 Prima 31228 Prinz 30831 Prism 30705, 30831 Pro2 31345 ProCaster 31004 Proceed 30672
Proline
30672, 30651, 30686, 30833, 31004, 31483
Proscan 30522 Proson 30713 Prosonic 30699, 30752
ProVision
30699, 30730, 31163, 31321, 31923
Pye 30539, 30646
Q
QONIX 31051 Qwestar 30651
R
Radionette 30741, 30869, 31906, 32024 RadioShack 30571 Raite 30665
RCA
30522, 30571, 30717, 30790, 30822, 31022, 31132, 31769, 31913, 31965
Realistic 30571 REC 30490
Redstar
30759, 30763, 30770, 30788, 30898, 31345, 31923
Relisys 31347 Reoc 30752, 30768 Revoy 30699, 30841 Rex 30838 Richmond 31233 Rio 30869
Roadstar
30672, 30690, 30699, 30713, 30730, 30833, 30898, 31051, 31227
Rocksonic 30789 Ronin 30872 Rotel 30558, 30623 Rowa 30717, 30759, 30872, 31004 Rownsonic 30789
S
Saba 30651, 3055 Sabaki 30798 Saivod 30759, 30831, 31367
Page 91
PRESET CODE

Salora 30741 Sampo 30752, 31321, 31347
Samsung
30490, 30573, 30744, 30199, 30820, 30899, 31044, 31075, 31635, 31932
Sansui
30784, 30695, 30751, 30763, 30768, 31051, 31228, 31230, 31695, 31832
Sanyo
30670, 30675, 30695, 30713, 30873, 31228
Scan 30705, 30850 ScanMagic 30730, 31730 ScanSonic 31695 Schaub Lorenz 30770, 30788, 31115, 31151
Schneider
30539, 30646, 30651, 30705, 30713, 30774, 30783, 30788, 30790, 30831, 30869, 31367
Schwaiger 30752 Scientific Labs 30768
Scott
30672, 30651, 31005, 31036, 31233, 31423
Seeltech 31224, 31451
SEG
30798, 30665, 30713, 30763, 30872, 30884, 31483, 31530
Sensory Science 31158 Shanghai 30672
Sharp
30630, 30675, 30713, 30752, 31256, 32015, 32024
Sharper Image 31117 Sherwood 30717, 30741, 30770 Shinco 30717 Shinsonic 30533, 30839 Siemssen 31382 Sigmatek 31005, 31224 Siltex 31224 Silva 30788, 30898 Silva Schneider 30831, 30898 SilverCrest 31152 Simaudio 30885 Singer 30690, 30751, 30768 Sistemas 30672 Skantic 30539, 30713 Skymaster 30730, 30768 Skyworth 30898 Sliding 31115 Slim Art 30784 SM Electronic 30690, 30730, 30768, 31152 Smart 30705, 30713 Sonai 30755 Sonashi 30831
Sonic Blue
30573, 30715, 30783, 30869, 31099
Sony
30533, 31533, 30864, 30573, 30630, 30772, 31033, 31070, 31431, 31433, 31536, 31633, 31769, 31981, 32043
Sound Color 31233 Soundmaster 30768
Soundmax 30768 Soundwave 30783 Spectra 30872
Standard
30651, 30768, 30788, 30831,
30898 Star Clusters 31152, 31227
Starlogic 31005 Starmedia 31005, 31224 Stevison 31367 Strong 30713 Sunkai 30770, 30850 Sunstech 30831 Sunwood 30788, 30898 Superscan 30821 Supervision 30768, 31152 SVA 30672, 30717, 30752, 31105 Sylvania 30630, 30675, 30821, 31268 Symphonic 30675, 30821, 31268 Synn 30768
T
Tandberg 30713, 31695 Tangent 31321 Targa 31227 Tatung 30770, 31695 Tchibo 30741 TCL 31180 TCM 30741, 30790
Teac
30571, 30717, 30675, 30741,
30759, 30768, 30790, 30833,
31006, 31197, 31227 Tec 30898
Technica 31367, 31695 Technics 30490, 30703, 31905 Technika 30770, 30831, 31115, 31695 Technisson 31115 Technosonic 30730, 31051, 31115 Techwood 30713, 31530 Tedelex 30690, 30768, 31004, 31228
Telefunken
30789, 30790, 30833, 31483,
31832, 31923 Teletech 30713, 30768
Tensai 30651, 30690, 30770
Tevion
30651, 30798, 30768, 30833,
30898, 31036, 31227, 31347,
31382, 31483, 31730, 31923 Theta Digital 30571
Thomson 30522, 30511, 30551 Tivo 31503
Tokai
30784, 30665, 30788, 30790,
30898 Tom-Tec 30789
Top Suxess 31224
Toshiba
30503, 30573, 30539, 30695,
31045, 31154, 31503, 31510,
31769 TRANS-continents 30831, 30872, 31321, 31327
Transonic 30730
Tredex 30843 TruVision 31451 Tsinghua Tongfang 31205 TSM 31224
U
Umax 30690, 31151 Unimax 30770
United
30675, 30695, 30699, 30713, 30730, 30788, 30884, 31115, 31152, 31228, 31367, 31832
Universum
30591, 30713, 30741, 30790, 30869, 31227, 31530, 31913
Uptek 30763 upXus 31345 Urban Concepts 30503, 30539 US Logic 30839
V
Venturer 30790 Vestel 30713, 30884, 31530 Victor 31597 Vieta 30705 Viewmaster 30862, 31224 Voxson 30690, 30730, 30774, 30831 Vtrek 31228
W
Waitec 31151, 31224, 31233 Walkvision 30717 Waltham 31530 Welkin 30831 Wellington 30713 Weltstar 30713 Wesder 30699
Wharfedale
30686, 30751, 30752, 30790, 31832
Wilson 30831, 31233 Windsor 30713 Windy Sam 30573 WIZE 31115 Woxter 31005, 31151, 31224
X
Xbox 30522, 31708 Xenius 30790 XLogic 30768, 31152, 31228 XMS 30770, 30788 Xoro 31183, 31250
Y
Yakumo 31004, 31056
Yamada
30872, 31004, 31056, 31151, 31158
Yamaha
30490, 30539, 30646, 30545, 31354
Yamakawa 30665, 30872, 31104 Yukai 30730, 31730
Z
Zenith
30503, 30591, 30741, 30869, 31906
Zeus 30784
DVD Recorder
1
4Kus 31158
A
Airis 31321 Akira 31321 Alba 31530 Apex Digital 31056 Aristona 30646 Aspire Digital 31168
B
Belson 31086
C
Cat 31421 cello 31730 Centrum 31227 Classic 31730 Coby 31086 Commax 31321 Conia 31321 CyberHome 31129, 31502 Cytron 31347
D
Denon 30490 Denver 31056 Digitrex 31056 DSE 31730 Durabrand 31502
E
E:max 31321 Ellion 31421 Eltax 31321 Emerson 30675
F
Ferguson 31730 Firstline 31530 Funai 30675
G
Gateway 31158 Go Video 30741, 31158, 31730 Goodmans 31530, 31730 GPX 30741 Grundig 31730
H
H & B 31421 Humax 30646
I
iLo 31348
J
JVC 31164, 31597
K
Kansas Technologies 31530 Kreisen 31421 KXD 31321
L
LG 30741 Lifetec 31347 LiteOn 31158 Loewe 30741 Lumatron 31321 Luxor 31730
M
Magnavox 30646, 30675 Matsui 31730 Maxent 31347 MBO 31730 Medion 31347 MiCO 30751
Mitsubishi 31403 Mustek 31730
N
NEC 31404
O
Oopla 31158
P
Palsonic 31056, 31321 Panasonic 30490, 31579 Philips 30646, 31158 Pioneer 30631 Polaroid 31086 ProVision 31321 Pye 30646
R
RCA 30522 Relisys 31347 Roadstar 31227
S
Sampo 31347 Samsung 30490, 31635 ScanMagic 31730 Schneider 30646 SEG 31530 Sensory Science 31158 Sharp 30630, 30675
Sony
31033, 31070, 31431, 31433, 31536
Star Clusters 31227 Sylvania 30675
T
Tangent 31321 Targa 31227 Teac 31227 Techwood 31530 Tevion 31227, 31347, 31730 Thomson 30551 Toshiba 31510
U
Universum 31227, 31530
V
Vestel 31530 Victor 31597
W
Waltham 31530
Y
Yakumo 31056 Yamada 31056, 31158 Yamaha 30646 Yukai 31730
Z
Zenith 30741
Page 92
DVD preset codes / Codes préréglés DVD
DENON Model No. / Modéle numéro
32134 (default / défaut) 30490
DVD-555 DVD-755 DVD-900 DVD-910 DVD-955 DVD-1000 DVD-1200 DVD-1500 DVD-1710 DVD-1910 DVD-1930CI DVD-2200 DVD-2800 DVD-2800g DVD-2900
DVD-2910 DVD-2930CI DVD-3800 DVD-3910 DVD-3930CI DVD-5900 DVD-5910 DVD-9000 DVM-715 DVM-1800 DVM-1805 DVM-1815 DVM-2815 DVM-4800
DVD-800 DVD-1600 DVD-2000 DVD-2500 DVD-3000 DVD-3300
[ ]z: Preset codes set upon shipment from the
factory.
b1 : These preset codes can be recorded in the SAT/
CBL mode.
b2 : These preset codes can be recorded in the TV
mode.
b3 : These preset codes can be recorded in the VCR
mode.
b4 : These preset codes can be recorded in the DVD
mode.
PRESET CODE

Page 93
Denon Brand Company, D&M Holdings Inc.
Printed in Japan 00D 511 4666 102
www.denon.com
Loading...